annotate runtime/doc/syntax.txt @ 2965:f2de38a019a2

Updated runtime files. Add missing test82 files.
author Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
date Mon, 18 Jul 2011 19:40:27 +0200
parents 3c7da93eb7f9
children 887d6d91882e
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
2965
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
1 *syntax.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2011 Jul 18
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7 Syntax highlighting *syntax* *syntax-highlighting* *coloring*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
9 Syntax highlighting enables Vim to show parts of the text in another font or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
10 color. Those parts can be specific keywords or text matching a pattern. Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
11 doesn't parse the whole file (to keep it fast), so the highlighting has its
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
12 limitations. Lexical highlighting might be a better name, but since everybody
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
13 calls it syntax highlighting we'll stick with that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
14
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
15 Vim supports syntax highlighting on all terminals. But since most ordinary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
16 terminals have very limited highlighting possibilities, it works best in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
17 GUI version, gvim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
18
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
19 In the User Manual:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
20 |usr_06.txt| introduces syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
21 |usr_44.txt| introduces writing a syntax file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
22
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
23 1. Quick start |:syn-qstart|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
24 2. Syntax files |:syn-files|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
25 3. Syntax loading procedure |syntax-loading|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
26 4. Syntax file remarks |:syn-file-remarks|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
27 5. Defining a syntax |:syn-define|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
28 6. :syntax arguments |:syn-arguments|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
29 7. Syntax patterns |:syn-pattern|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
30 8. Syntax clusters |:syn-cluster|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
31 9. Including syntax files |:syn-include|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
32 10. Synchronizing |:syn-sync|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
33 11. Listing syntax items |:syntax|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
34 12. Highlight command |:highlight|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
35 13. Linking groups |:highlight-link|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
36 14. Cleaning up |:syn-clear|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
37 15. Highlighting tags |tag-highlight|
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
38 16. Window-local syntax |:ownsyntax|
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
39 17. Color xterms |xterm-color|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
40
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
41 {Vi does not have any of these commands}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
42
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
43 Syntax highlighting is not available when the |+syntax| feature has been
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
44 disabled at compile time.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
45
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
46 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
47 1. Quick start *:syn-qstart*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
48
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
49 *:syn-enable* *:syntax-enable*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
50 This command switches on syntax highlighting: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
51
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
52 :syntax enable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
53
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
54 What this command actually does is to execute the command >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
55 :source $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
56
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
57 If the VIM environment variable is not set, Vim will try to find
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
58 the path in another way (see |$VIMRUNTIME|). Usually this works just
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
59 fine. If it doesn't, try setting the VIM environment variable to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
60 directory where the Vim stuff is located. For example, if your syntax files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
61 are in the "/usr/vim/vim50/syntax" directory, set $VIMRUNTIME to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
62 "/usr/vim/vim50". You must do this in the shell, before starting Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
63
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
64 *:syn-on* *:syntax-on*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
65 The ":syntax enable" command will keep your current color settings. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
66 allows using ":highlight" commands to set your preferred colors before or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
67 after using this command. If you want Vim to overrule your settings with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
68 defaults, use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
69 :syntax on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
70 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
71 *:hi-normal* *:highlight-normal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
72 If you are running in the GUI, you can get white text on a black background
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
73 with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
74 :highlight Normal guibg=Black guifg=White
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
75 For a color terminal see |:hi-normal-cterm|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
76 For setting up your own colors syntax highlighting see |syncolor|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
77
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
78 NOTE: The syntax files on MS-DOS and Windows have lines that end in <CR><NL>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
79 The files for Unix end in <NL>. This means you should use the right type of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
80 file for your system. Although on MS-DOS and Windows the right format is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
81 automatically selected if the 'fileformats' option is not empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
82
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
83 NOTE: When using reverse video ("gvim -fg white -bg black"), the default value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
84 of 'background' will not be set until the GUI window is opened, which is after
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
85 reading the |gvimrc|. This will cause the wrong default highlighting to be
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
86 used. To set the default value of 'background' before switching on
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
87 highlighting, include the ":gui" command in the |gvimrc|: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
88
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
89 :gui " open window and set default for 'background'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
90 :syntax on " start highlighting, use 'background' to set colors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
91
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
92 NOTE: Using ":gui" in the |gvimrc| means that "gvim -f" won't start in the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
93 foreground! Use ":gui -f" then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
94
2520
6768ebd0bc04 Remove unused code.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2496
diff changeset
95 *g:syntax_on*
6768ebd0bc04 Remove unused code.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2496
diff changeset
96 You can toggle the syntax on/off with this command: >
6768ebd0bc04 Remove unused code.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2496
diff changeset
97 :if exists("g:syntax_on") | syntax off | else | syntax enable | endif
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
98
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
99 To put this into a mapping, you can use: >
2520
6768ebd0bc04 Remove unused code.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2496
diff changeset
100 :map <F7> :if exists("g:syntax_on") <Bar>
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
101 \ syntax off <Bar>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
102 \ else <Bar>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
103 \ syntax enable <Bar>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
104 \ endif <CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
105 [using the |<>| notation, type this literally]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
106
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
107 Details:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
108 The ":syntax" commands are implemented by sourcing a file. To see exactly how
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
109 this works, look in the file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
110 command file ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
111 :syntax enable $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
112 :syntax on $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
113 :syntax manual $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/manual.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
114 :syntax off $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/nosyntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
115 Also see |syntax-loading|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
116
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
117 NOTE: If displaying long lines is slow and switching off syntax highlighting
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
118 makes it fast, consider setting the 'synmaxcol' option to a lower value.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
119
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
120 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
121 2. Syntax files *:syn-files*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
122
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
123 The syntax and highlighting commands for one language are normally stored in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
124 a syntax file. The name convention is: "{name}.vim". Where {name} is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
125 name of the language, or an abbreviation (to fit the name in 8.3 characters,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
126 a requirement in case the file is used on a DOS filesystem).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
127 Examples:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
128 c.vim perl.vim java.vim html.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
129 cpp.vim sh.vim csh.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
130
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
131 The syntax file can contain any Ex commands, just like a vimrc file. But
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
132 the idea is that only commands for a specific language are included. When a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
133 language is a superset of another language, it may include the other one,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
134 for example, the cpp.vim file could include the c.vim file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
135 :so $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/c.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
136
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
137 The .vim files are normally loaded with an autocommand. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
138 :au Syntax c runtime! syntax/c.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
139 :au Syntax cpp runtime! syntax/cpp.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
140 These commands are normally in the file $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/synload.vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
141
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
142
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
143 MAKING YOUR OWN SYNTAX FILES *mysyntaxfile*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
144
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
145 When you create your own syntax files, and you want to have Vim use these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
146 automatically with ":syntax enable", do this:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
147
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
148 1. Create your user runtime directory. You would normally use the first item
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
149 of the 'runtimepath' option. Example for Unix: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
150 mkdir ~/.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
151
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
152 2. Create a directory in there called "syntax". For Unix: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
153 mkdir ~/.vim/syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
154
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
155 3. Write the Vim syntax file. Or download one from the internet. Then write
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
156 it in your syntax directory. For example, for the "mine" syntax: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
157 :w ~/.vim/syntax/mine.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
158
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
159 Now you can start using your syntax file manually: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
160 :set syntax=mine
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
161 You don't have to exit Vim to use this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
162
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
163 If you also want Vim to detect the type of file, see |new-filetype|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
164
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
165 If you are setting up a system with many users and you don't want each user
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
166 to add the same syntax file, you can use another directory from 'runtimepath'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
167
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
168
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
169 ADDING TO AN EXISTING SYNTAX FILE *mysyntaxfile-add*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
170
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
171 If you are mostly satisfied with an existing syntax file, but would like to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
172 add a few items or change the highlighting, follow these steps:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
173
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
174 1. Create your user directory from 'runtimepath', see above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
175
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
176 2. Create a directory in there called "after/syntax". For Unix: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
177 mkdir ~/.vim/after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
178 mkdir ~/.vim/after/syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
179
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
180 3. Write a Vim script that contains the commands you want to use. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
181 example, to change the colors for the C syntax: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
182 highlight cComment ctermfg=Green guifg=Green
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
183
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
184 4. Write that file in the "after/syntax" directory. Use the name of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
185 syntax, with ".vim" added. For our C syntax: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
186 :w ~/.vim/after/syntax/c.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
187
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
188 That's it. The next time you edit a C file the Comment color will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
189 different. You don't even have to restart Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
190
169
0e902b8f511f updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
191 If you have multiple files, you can use the filetype as the directory name.
0e902b8f511f updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
192 All the "*.vim" files in this directory will be used, for example:
0e902b8f511f updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
193 ~/.vim/after/syntax/c/one.vim
0e902b8f511f updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
194 ~/.vim/after/syntax/c/two.vim
0e902b8f511f updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
195
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
196
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
197 REPLACING AN EXISTING SYNTAX FILE *mysyntaxfile-replace*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
198
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
199 If you don't like a distributed syntax file, or you have downloaded a new
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
200 version, follow the same steps as for |mysyntaxfile| above. Just make sure
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
201 that you write the syntax file in a directory that is early in 'runtimepath'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
202 Vim will only load the first syntax file found.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
203
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
204
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
205 NAMING CONVENTIONS *group-name* *{group-name}* *E669* *W18*
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
206
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
207 A syntax group name is to be used for syntax items that match the same kind of
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
208 thing. These are then linked to a highlight group that specifies the color.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
209 A syntax group name doesn't specify any color or attributes itself.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
210
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
211 The name for a highlight or syntax group must consist of ASCII letters, digits
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
212 and the underscore. As a regexp: "[a-zA-Z0-9_]*"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
213
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
214 To be able to allow each user to pick his favorite set of colors, there must
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
215 be preferred names for highlight groups that are common for many languages.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
216 These are the suggested group names (if syntax highlighting works properly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
217 you can see the actual color, except for "Ignore"):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
218
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
219 *Comment any comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
220
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
221 *Constant any constant
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
222 String a string constant: "this is a string"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
223 Character a character constant: 'c', '\n'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
224 Number a number constant: 234, 0xff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
225 Boolean a boolean constant: TRUE, false
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
226 Float a floating point constant: 2.3e10
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
227
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
228 *Identifier any variable name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
229 Function function name (also: methods for classes)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
230
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
231 *Statement any statement
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
232 Conditional if, then, else, endif, switch, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
233 Repeat for, do, while, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
234 Label case, default, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
235 Operator "sizeof", "+", "*", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
236 Keyword any other keyword
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
237 Exception try, catch, throw
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
238
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
239 *PreProc generic Preprocessor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
240 Include preprocessor #include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
241 Define preprocessor #define
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
242 Macro same as Define
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
243 PreCondit preprocessor #if, #else, #endif, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
244
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
245 *Type int, long, char, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
246 StorageClass static, register, volatile, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
247 Structure struct, union, enum, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
248 Typedef A typedef
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
249
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
250 *Special any special symbol
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
251 SpecialChar special character in a constant
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
252 Tag you can use CTRL-] on this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
253 Delimiter character that needs attention
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
254 SpecialComment special things inside a comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
255 Debug debugging statements
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
256
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
257 *Underlined text that stands out, HTML links
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
258
2386
fb8cce4174f0 Better text for 'concealcursor' in :options window.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
259 *Ignore left blank, hidden |hl-Ignore|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
260
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
261 *Error any erroneous construct
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
262
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
263 *Todo anything that needs extra attention; mostly the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
264 keywords TODO FIXME and XXX
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
265
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
266 The names marked with * are the preferred groups; the others are minor groups.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
267 For the preferred groups, the "syntax.vim" file contains default highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
268 The minor groups are linked to the preferred groups, so they get the same
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
269 highlighting. You can override these defaults by using ":highlight" commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
270 after sourcing the "syntax.vim" file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
271
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
272 Note that highlight group names are not case sensitive. "String" and "string"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
273 can be used for the same group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
274
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
275 The following names are reserved and cannot be used as a group name:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
276 NONE ALL ALLBUT contains contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
277
2386
fb8cce4174f0 Better text for 'concealcursor' in :options window.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
278 *hl-Ignore*
fb8cce4174f0 Better text for 'concealcursor' in :options window.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
279 When using the Ignore group, you may also consider using the conceal
fb8cce4174f0 Better text for 'concealcursor' in :options window.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
280 mechanism. See |conceal|.
fb8cce4174f0 Better text for 'concealcursor' in :options window.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
281
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
282 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
283 3. Syntax loading procedure *syntax-loading*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
284
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
285 This explains the details that happen when the command ":syntax enable" is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
286 issued. When Vim initializes itself, it finds out where the runtime files are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
287 located. This is used here as the variable |$VIMRUNTIME|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
288
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
289 ":syntax enable" and ":syntax on" do the following:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
290
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
291 Source $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
292 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
293 +- Clear out any old syntax by sourcing $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/nosyntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
294 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
295 +- Source first syntax/synload.vim in 'runtimepath'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
296 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
297 | +- Setup the colors for syntax highlighting. If a color scheme is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
298 | | defined it is loaded again with ":colors {name}". Otherwise
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
299 | | ":runtime! syntax/syncolor.vim" is used. ":syntax on" overrules
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
300 | | existing colors, ":syntax enable" only sets groups that weren't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
301 | | set yet.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
302 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
303 | +- Set up syntax autocmds to load the appropriate syntax file when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
304 | | the 'syntax' option is set. *synload-1*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
305 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
306 | +- Source the user's optional file, from the |mysyntaxfile| variable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
307 | This is for backwards compatibility with Vim 5.x only. *synload-2*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
308 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
309 +- Do ":filetype on", which does ":runtime! filetype.vim". It loads any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
310 | filetype.vim files found. It should always Source
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
311 | $VIMRUNTIME/filetype.vim, which does the following.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
312 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
313 | +- Install autocmds based on suffix to set the 'filetype' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
314 | | This is where the connection between file name and file type is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
315 | | made for known file types. *synload-3*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
316 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
317 | +- Source the user's optional file, from the *myfiletypefile*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
318 | | variable. This is for backwards compatibility with Vim 5.x only.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
319 | | *synload-4*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
320 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
321 | +- Install one autocommand which sources scripts.vim when no file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
322 | | type was detected yet. *synload-5*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
323 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
324 | +- Source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim, to setup the Syntax menu. |menu.vim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
325 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
326 +- Install a FileType autocommand to set the 'syntax' option when a file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
327 | type has been detected. *synload-6*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
328 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
329 +- Execute syntax autocommands to start syntax highlighting for each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
330 already loaded buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
331
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
332
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
333 Upon loading a file, Vim finds the relevant syntax file as follows:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
334
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
335 Loading the file triggers the BufReadPost autocommands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
336 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
337 +- If there is a match with one of the autocommands from |synload-3|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
338 | (known file types) or |synload-4| (user's file types), the 'filetype'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
339 | option is set to the file type.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
340 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
341 +- The autocommand at |synload-5| is triggered. If the file type was not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
342 | found yet, then scripts.vim is searched for in 'runtimepath'. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
343 | should always load $VIMRUNTIME/scripts.vim, which does the following.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
344 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
345 | +- Source the user's optional file, from the *myscriptsfile*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
346 | | variable. This is for backwards compatibility with Vim 5.x only.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
347 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
348 | +- If the file type is still unknown, check the contents of the file,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
349 | again with checks like "getline(1) =~ pattern" as to whether the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
350 | file type can be recognized, and set 'filetype'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
351 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
352 +- When the file type was determined and 'filetype' was set, this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
353 | triggers the FileType autocommand |synload-6| above. It sets
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
354 | 'syntax' to the determined file type.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
355 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
356 +- When the 'syntax' option was set above, this triggers an autocommand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
357 | from |synload-1| (and |synload-2|). This find the main syntax file in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
358 | 'runtimepath', with this command:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
359 | runtime! syntax/<name>.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
360 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
361 +- Any other user installed FileType or Syntax autocommands are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
362 triggered. This can be used to change the highlighting for a specific
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
363 syntax.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
364
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
365 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
366 4. Syntax file remarks *:syn-file-remarks*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
367
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
368 *b:current_syntax-variable*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
369 Vim stores the name of the syntax that has been loaded in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
370 "b:current_syntax" variable. You can use this if you want to load other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
371 settings, depending on which syntax is active. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
372 :au BufReadPost * if b:current_syntax == "csh"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
373 :au BufReadPost * do-some-things
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
374 :au BufReadPost * endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
375
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
376
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
377 2HTML *2html.vim* *convert-to-HTML*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
378
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
379 This is not a syntax file itself, but a script that converts the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
380 window into HTML. Vim opens a new window in which it builds the HTML file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
381
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
382 You are not supposed to set the 'filetype' or 'syntax' option to "2html"!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
383 Source the script to convert the current file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
384
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
385 :runtime! syntax/2html.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
386 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
387 *:TOhtml*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
388 Or use the ":TOhtml" user command. It is defined in a standard plugin.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
389 ":TOhtml" also works with a range and in a Visual area: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
390
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
391 :10,40TOhtml
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
392
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
393 Warning: This can be slow! The script must process every character of every
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
394 line. Because it can take a long time, by default a progress bar is displayed
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
395 in the statusline for each major step in the conversion process. If you don't
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
396 like seeing this progress bar, you can disable it and get a very minor speed
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
397 improvement with: >
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
398
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
399 let g:html_no_progress = 1
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
400
2304
a59e6ac5ed28 When the buffer is in diff mode, have :TOhtml create HTML to show the diff
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2296
diff changeset
401 ":TOhtml" has another special feature: if the window is in diff mode, it will
a59e6ac5ed28 When the buffer is in diff mode, have :TOhtml create HTML to show the diff
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2296
diff changeset
402 generate HTML that shows all the related windows. This can be disabled by
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
403 setting the g:html_diff_one_file variable: >
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
404
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
405 let g:html_diff_one_file = 1
2304
a59e6ac5ed28 When the buffer is in diff mode, have :TOhtml create HTML to show the diff
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2296
diff changeset
406
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
407 After you save the resulting file, you can view it with any browser. The
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
408 colors should be exactly the same as you see them in Vim.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
409
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
410 To restrict the conversion to a range of lines, use a range with the |:TOhtml|
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
411 command, or set "g:html_start_line" and "g:html_end_line" to the first and
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
412 last line to be converted. Example, using the last set Visual area: >
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
413
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
414 :let g:html_start_line = line("'<")
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
415 :let g:html_end_line = line("'>")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
416
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
417 The lines are numbered according to 'number' option and the Number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
418 highlighting. You can force lines to be numbered in the HTML output by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
419 setting "html_number_lines" to non-zero value: >
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
420 :let g:html_number_lines = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
421 Force to omit the line numbers by using a zero value: >
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
422 :let g:html_number_lines = 0
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
423 Go back to the default to use 'number' by deleting the variable: >
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
424 :unlet g:html_number_lines
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
425
2496
a29075150aee Improve handling of user settings in :TOhtml. Default to generating CSS.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2494
diff changeset
426 By default, valid HTML 4.01 using cascading style sheets (CSS1) is generated.
a29075150aee Improve handling of user settings in :TOhtml. Default to generating CSS.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2494
diff changeset
427 If you need to generate markup for really old browsers or some other user
a29075150aee Improve handling of user settings in :TOhtml. Default to generating CSS.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2494
diff changeset
428 agent that lacks basic CSS support, use: >
a29075150aee Improve handling of user settings in :TOhtml. Default to generating CSS.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2494
diff changeset
429 :let g:html_use_css = 0
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
430
2401
e7751177126b Add the synconcealed() function and use it for :TOhtml. (Benjamin Fritz)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2398
diff changeset
431 Concealed text is removed from the HTML and replaced with the appropriate
2410
8f6106dd3d12 Fix: editing a not encrypted file after a crypted file messed up reading the
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2401
diff changeset
432 character from |:syn-cchar| or 'listchars' depending on the current value of
2401
e7751177126b Add the synconcealed() function and use it for :TOhtml. (Benjamin Fritz)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2398
diff changeset
433 'conceallevel'. If you always want to display all text in your document,
2432
80229a724a11 Updated runtime files. :TOhtml improvements by Benjamin Fritz.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2426
diff changeset
434 either set 'conceallevel' to zero before invoking 2html, or use: >
2401
e7751177126b Add the synconcealed() function and use it for :TOhtml. (Benjamin Fritz)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2398
diff changeset
435 :let g:html_ignore_conceal = 1
e7751177126b Add the synconcealed() function and use it for :TOhtml. (Benjamin Fritz)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2398
diff changeset
436
e7751177126b Add the synconcealed() function and use it for :TOhtml. (Benjamin Fritz)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2398
diff changeset
437 Similarly, closed folds are put in the HTML as they are displayed. If you
e7751177126b Add the synconcealed() function and use it for :TOhtml. (Benjamin Fritz)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2398
diff changeset
438 don't want this, use the |zR| command before invoking 2html, or use: >
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
439 :let g:html_ignore_folding = 1
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
440
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
441 You may want to generate HTML that includes all the data within the folds, and
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
442 allow the user to view the folded data similar to how they would in Vim. To
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
443 generate this dynamic fold information, use: >
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
444 :let g:html_dynamic_folds = 1
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
445
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
446 Using html_dynamic_folds will imply html_use_css, because it would be far too
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
447 difficult to do it for old browsers. However, html_ignore_folding overrides
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
448 html_dynamic_folds.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
449
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
450 Using html_dynamic_folds will default to generating a foldcolumn in the html
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
451 similar to Vim's foldcolumn, that will use javascript to open and close the
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
452 folds in the HTML document. The width of this foldcolumn starts at the current
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
453 setting of |'foldcolumn'| but grows to fit the greatest foldlevel in your
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
454 document. If you do not want to show a foldcolumn at all, use: >
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
455 :let g:html_no_foldcolumn = 1
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
456
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
457 Using this option, there will be no foldcolumn available to open the folds in
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
458 the HTML. For this reason, another option is provided: html_hover_unfold.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
459 Enabling this option will use CSS 2.0 to allow a user to open a fold by
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
460 hovering the mouse pointer over it. Note that old browsers (notably Internet
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
461 Explorer 6) will not support this feature. Browser-specific markup for IE6 is
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
462 included to fall back to the normal CSS1 code so that the folds show up
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
463 correctly for this browser, but they will not be openable without a
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
464 foldcolumn. Note that using html_hover_unfold will allow modern browsers with
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
465 disabled javascript to view closed folds. To use this option, use: >
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
466 :let g:html_hover_unfold = 1
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
467
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
468 Setting html_no_foldcolumn with html_dynamic_folds will automatically set
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
469 html_hover_unfold, because otherwise the folds wouldn't be dynamic.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
470
2788
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
471 By default "<pre>" and "</pre>" are used around the text. When 'wrap' is set
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
472 in the window being converted, the CSS 2.0 "white-space:pre-wrap" value is
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
473 used to wrap the text. You can explicitly enable the wrapping with: >
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
474 :let g:html_pre_wrap = 1
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
475 or disable with >
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
476 :let g:html_pre_wrap = 0
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
477 This generates HTML that looks very close to the Vim window, but unfortunately
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
478 there can be minor differences such as the lack of a 'showbreak' option in in
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
479 the HTML, or where line breaks can occur.
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
480
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
481 Another way to obtain text wrapping in the HTML, at the risk of making some
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
482 things look even more different, is to use: >
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
483 :let g:html_no_pre = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
484 This will use <br> at the end of each line and use "&nbsp;" for repeated
2788
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
485 spaces. Doing it this way is more compatible with old browsers, but modern
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
486 browsers support the "white-space" method.
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
487
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
488 If you do stick with the default "<pre>" tags, <Tab> characters in the text
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
489 are included in the generated output if they will have no effect on the
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
490 appearance of the text and it looks like they are in the document
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
491 intentionally. This allows for the HTML output to be copied and pasted from a
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
492 browser without losing the actual whitespace used in the document.
2681
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
493
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
494 Specifically, <Tab> characters will be included if the 'tabstop' option is set
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
495 to the default of 8, 'expandtab' is not set, and if neither the foldcolumn nor
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
496 the line numbers are included in the HTML output (see options above). When any
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
497 of these conditions are not met, any <Tab> characters in the text are expanded
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
498 to the appropriate number of spaces in the HTML output.
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
499
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
500 When "<pre>" is included, you can force |:TOhtml| to keep the tabs even if the
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
501 other conditions are not met with: >
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
502 :let g:html_expand_tabs = 0
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
503 Note that this can easily break text alignment and indentation in the HTML.
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
504
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
505 Force tabs to be expanded even when they would be kept using: >
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
506 :let g:html_expand_tabs = 1
85c5a72551e2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
507
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
508 For diff mode on a single file (with g:html_diff_one_file) a sequence of more
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
509 than 3 filler lines is displayed as three lines with the middle line
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
510 mentioning the total number of inserted lines. If you prefer to see all the
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
511 inserted lines as with the side-by-side diff, use: >
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
512 :let g:html_whole_filler = 1
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
513 And to go back to displaying up to three lines again: >
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
514 :unlet g:html_whole_filler
2788
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
515
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
516 For most buffers, TOhtml uses the current value of 'fileencoding' if set, or
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
517 'encoding' if not, to determine the charset and 'fileencoding' of the HTML
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
518 file. 'encoding' is always used for certain 'buftype' values. In general, this
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
519 works for the encodings mentioned specifically by name in |encoding-names|,
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
520 but TOhtml will only automatically use those encodings which are widely
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
521 supported. However, you can override this to support specific encodings that
0877b8d6370e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2751
diff changeset
522 may not be automatically detected by default.
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
523
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
524 To overrule all automatic charset detection, set g:html_use_encoding to the
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
525 name of the charset to be used. TOhtml will try to determine the appropriate
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
526 'fileencoding' setting from the charset, but you may need to set it manually
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
527 if TOhtml cannot determine the encoding. It is recommended to set this
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
528 variable to something widely supported, like UTF-8, for anything you will be
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
529 hosting on a webserver: >
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
530 :let g:html_use_encoding = "UTF-8"
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
531 You can also use this option to omit the line that specifies the charset
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
532 entirely, by setting g:html_use_encoding to an empty string: >
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
533 :let g:html_use_encoding = ""
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
534 To go back to the automatic mechanism, delete the g:html_use_encoding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
535 variable: >
2321
1902913f2049 Improved version of 2html.vim.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2314
diff changeset
536 :unlet g:html_use_encoding
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
537
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
538 If you specify a charset with g:html_use_encoding for which TOhtml cannot
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
539 automatically detect the corresponding 'fileencoding' setting, you can use
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
540 g:html_encoding_override to allow TOhtml to detect the correct encoding.
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
541 This is a dictionary of charset-encoding pairs that will replace existing
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
542 pairs automatically detected by TOhtml, or supplement with new pairs. For
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
543 example, to allow TOhtml to detect the HTML charset "windows-1252" properly as
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
544 the encoding "8bit-cp1252", use: >
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
545 :let g:html_encoding_override = {'windows-1252': '8bit-cp1252'}
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
546 <
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
547 The g:html_charset_override is similar, it allows TOhtml to detect the HTML
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
548 charset for any 'fileencoding' or 'encoding' which is not detected
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
549 automatically. You can also use it to override specific existing
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
550 encoding-charset pairs. For example, TOhtml will by default use UTF-8 for all
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
551 Unicode/UCS encodings. To use UTF-16 and UTF-32 instead, use: >
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
552 :let g:html_charset_override = {'ucs-4': 'UTF-32', 'utf-16': 'UTF-16'}
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
553
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
554 Note that documents encoded in either UTF-32 or UTF-16 have known
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
555 compatibility problems with at least one major browser.
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
556
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
557 *convert-to-XML* *convert-to-XHTML*
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
558 If you do not like plain HTML, an alternative is to have the script generate
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
559 XHTML (XML compliant HTML). To do this set the "html_use_xhtml" variable: >
2496
a29075150aee Improve handling of user settings in :TOhtml. Default to generating CSS.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2494
diff changeset
560 :let g:html_use_xhtml = 1
a29075150aee Improve handling of user settings in :TOhtml. Default to generating CSS.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2494
diff changeset
561
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
562 Any of the on/off options listed above can be enabled or disabled by setting
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
563 them explicitly to the desired value, or restored to their default by removing
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
564 the variable using |:unlet|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
565
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
566 Remarks:
2496
a29075150aee Improve handling of user settings in :TOhtml. Default to generating CSS.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2494
diff changeset
567 - Some truly ancient browsers may not show the background colors.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
568 - From most browsers you can also print the file (in color)!
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
569 - This version of TOhtml may work with older versions of Vim, but some
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
570 features such as conceal support will not function, and the colors may be
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
571 incorrect for an old Vim without GUI support compiled in.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
572
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
573 Here is an example how to run the script over all .c and .h files from a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
574 Unix shell: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
575 for f in *.[ch]; do gvim -f +"syn on" +"run! syntax/2html.vim" +"wq" +"q" $f; done
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
576 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
577
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
578 ABEL *abel.vim* *ft-abel-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
579
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
580 ABEL highlighting provides some user-defined options. To enable them, assign
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
581 any value to the respective variable. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
582 :let abel_obsolete_ok=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
583 To disable them use ":unlet". Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
584 :unlet abel_obsolete_ok
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
585
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
586 Variable Highlight ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
587 abel_obsolete_ok obsolete keywords are statements, not errors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
588 abel_cpp_comments_illegal do not interpret '//' as inline comment leader
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
589
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
590
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
591 ADA
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
592
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
593 See |ft-ada-syntax|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
594
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
595
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
596 ANT *ant.vim* *ft-ant-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
597
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
598 The ant syntax file provides syntax highlighting for javascript and python
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
599 by default. Syntax highlighting for other script languages can be installed
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
600 by the function AntSyntaxScript(), which takes the tag name as first argument
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
601 and the script syntax file name as second argument. Example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
602
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
603 :call AntSyntaxScript('perl', 'perl.vim')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
604
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
605 will install syntax perl highlighting for the following ant code >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
606
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
607 <script language = 'perl'><![CDATA[
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
608 # everything inside is highlighted as perl
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
609 ]]></script>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
610
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
611 See |mysyntaxfile-add| for installing script languages permanently.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
612
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
613
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
614 APACHE *apache.vim* *ft-apache-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
615
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
616 The apache syntax file provides syntax highlighting depending on Apache HTTP
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
617 server version, by default for 1.3.x. Set "apache_version" to Apache version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
618 (as a string) to get highlighting for another version. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
619
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
620 :let apache_version = "2.0"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
621 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
622
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
623 *asm.vim* *asmh8300.vim* *nasm.vim* *masm.vim* *asm68k*
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
624 ASSEMBLY *ft-asm-syntax* *ft-asmh8300-syntax* *ft-nasm-syntax*
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
625 *ft-masm-syntax* *ft-asm68k-syntax* *fasm.vim*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
626
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
627 Files matching "*.i" could be Progress or Assembly. If the automatic detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
628 doesn't work for you, or you don't edit Progress at all, use this in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
629 startup vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
630 :let filetype_i = "asm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
631 Replace "asm" with the type of assembly you use.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
632
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
633 There are many types of assembly languages that all use the same file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
634 extensions. Therefore you will have to select the type yourself, or add a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
635 line in the assembly file that Vim will recognize. Currently these syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
636 files are included:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
637 asm GNU assembly (the default)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
638 asm68k Motorola 680x0 assembly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
639 asmh8300 Hitachi H-8300 version of GNU assembly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
640 ia64 Intel Itanium 64
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
641 fasm Flat assembly (http://flatassembler.net)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
642 masm Microsoft assembly (probably works for any 80x86)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
643 nasm Netwide assembly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
644 tasm Turbo Assembly (with opcodes 80x86 up to Pentium, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
645 MMX)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
646 pic PIC assembly (currently for PIC16F84)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
647
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
648 The most flexible is to add a line in your assembly file containing: >
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
649 asmsyntax=nasm
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
650 Replace "nasm" with the name of the real assembly syntax. This line must be
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
651 one of the first five lines in the file. No non-white text must be
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
652 immediately before or after this text.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
653
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
654 The syntax type can always be overruled for a specific buffer by setting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
655 b:asmsyntax variable: >
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
656 :let b:asmsyntax = "nasm"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
657
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
658 If b:asmsyntax is not set, either automatically or by hand, then the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
659 the global variable asmsyntax is used. This can be seen as a default assembly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
660 language: >
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
661 :let asmsyntax = "nasm"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
662
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
663 As a last resort, if nothing is defined, the "asm" syntax is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
664
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
665
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
666 Netwide assembler (nasm.vim) optional highlighting ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
667
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
668 To enable a feature: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
669 :let {variable}=1|set syntax=nasm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
670 To disable a feature: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
671 :unlet {variable} |set syntax=nasm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
672
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
673 Variable Highlight ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
674 nasm_loose_syntax unofficial parser allowed syntax not as Error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
675 (parser dependent; not recommended)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
676 nasm_ctx_outside_macro contexts outside macro not as Error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
677 nasm_no_warn potentially risky syntax not as ToDo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
678
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
679
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
680 ASPPERL and ASPVBS *ft-aspperl-syntax* *ft-aspvbs-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
681
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
682 *.asp and *.asa files could be either Perl or Visual Basic script. Since it's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
683 hard to detect this you can set two global variables to tell Vim what you are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
684 using. For Perl script use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
685 :let g:filetype_asa = "aspperl"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
686 :let g:filetype_asp = "aspperl"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
687 For Visual Basic use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
688 :let g:filetype_asa = "aspvbs"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
689 :let g:filetype_asp = "aspvbs"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
690
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
691
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
692 BAAN *baan.vim* *baan-syntax*
844
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
693
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
694 The baan.vim gives syntax support for BaanC of release BaanIV upto SSA ERP LN
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
695 for both 3 GL and 4 GL programming. Large number of standard defines/constants
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
696 are supported.
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
697
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
698 Some special violation of coding standards will be signalled when one specify
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
699 in ones |.vimrc|: >
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
700 let baan_code_stds=1
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
701
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
702 *baan-folding*
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
703
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
704 Syntax folding can be enabled at various levels through the variables
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
705 mentioned below (Set those in your |.vimrc|). The more complex folding on
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
706 source blocks and SQL can be CPU intensive.
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
707
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
708 To allow any folding and enable folding at function level use: >
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
709 let baan_fold=1
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
710 Folding can be enabled at source block level as if, while, for ,... The
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
711 indentation preceding the begin/end keywords has to match (spaces are not
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
712 considered equal to a tab). >
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
713 let baan_fold_block=1
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
714 Folding can be enabled for embedded SQL blocks as SELECT, SELECTDO,
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
715 SELECTEMPTY, ... The indentation preceding the begin/end keywords has to
844
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
716 match (spaces are not considered equal to a tab). >
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
717 let baan_fold_sql=1
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
718 Note: Block folding can result in many small folds. It is suggested to |:set|
844
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
719 the options 'foldminlines' and 'foldnestmax' in |.vimrc| or use |:setlocal| in
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
720 .../after/syntax/baan.vim (see |after-directory|). Eg: >
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
721 set foldminlines=5
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
722 set foldnestmax=6
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
723
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
724
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
725 BASIC *basic.vim* *vb.vim* *ft-basic-syntax* *ft-vb-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
726
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
727 Both Visual Basic and "normal" basic use the extension ".bas". To detect
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
728 which one should be used, Vim checks for the string "VB_Name" in the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
729 five lines of the file. If it is not found, filetype will be "basic",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
730 otherwise "vb". Files with the ".frm" extension will always be seen as Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
731 Basic.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
732
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
733
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
734 C *c.vim* *ft-c-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
735
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
736 A few things in C highlighting are optional. To enable them assign any value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
737 to the respective variable. Example: >
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
738 :let c_comment_strings = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
739 To disable them use ":unlet". Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
740 :unlet c_comment_strings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
741
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
742 Variable Highlight ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
743 c_gnu GNU gcc specific items
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
744 c_comment_strings strings and numbers inside a comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
745 c_space_errors trailing white space and spaces before a <Tab>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
746 c_no_trail_space_error ... but no trailing spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
747 c_no_tab_space_error ... but no spaces before a <Tab>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
748 c_no_bracket_error don't highlight {}; inside [] as errors
140
8ecb0db93e9a updated for version 7.0045
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
749 c_no_curly_error don't highlight {}; inside [] and () as errors;
8ecb0db93e9a updated for version 7.0045
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
750 except { and } in first column
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
751 c_curly_error highlight a missing }; this forces syncing from the
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
752 start of the file, can be slow
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
753 c_no_ansi don't do standard ANSI types and constants
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
754 c_ansi_typedefs ... but do standard ANSI types
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
755 c_ansi_constants ... but do standard ANSI constants
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
756 c_no_utf don't highlight \u and \U in strings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
757 c_syntax_for_h use C syntax for *.h files, instead of C++
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
758 c_no_if0 don't highlight "#if 0" blocks as comments
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
759 c_no_cformat don't highlight %-formats in strings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
760 c_no_c99 don't highlight C99 standard items
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
761
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 32
diff changeset
762 When 'foldmethod' is set to "syntax" then /* */ comments and { } blocks will
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 32
diff changeset
763 become a fold. If you don't want comments to become a fold use: >
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 32
diff changeset
764 :let c_no_comment_fold = 1
842
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
765 "#if 0" blocks are also folded, unless: >
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
766 :let c_no_if0_fold = 1
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 32
diff changeset
767
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
768 If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards, which are fixed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
769 when redrawing with CTRL-L, try setting the "c_minlines" internal variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
770 to a larger number: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
771 :let c_minlines = 100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
772 This will make the syntax synchronization start 100 lines before the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
773 displayed line. The default value is 50 (15 when c_no_if0 is set). The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
774 disadvantage of using a larger number is that redrawing can become slow.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
775
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
776 When using the "#if 0" / "#endif" comment highlighting, notice that this only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
777 works when the "#if 0" is within "c_minlines" from the top of the window. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
778 you have a long "#if 0" construct it will not be highlighted correctly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
779
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
780 To match extra items in comments, use the cCommentGroup cluster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
781 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
782 :au Syntax c call MyCadd()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
783 :function MyCadd()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
784 : syn keyword cMyItem contained Ni
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
785 : syn cluster cCommentGroup add=cMyItem
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
786 : hi link cMyItem Title
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
787 :endfun
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
788
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
789 ANSI constants will be highlighted with the "cConstant" group. This includes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
790 "NULL", "SIG_IGN" and others. But not "TRUE", for example, because this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
791 not in the ANSI standard. If you find this confusing, remove the cConstant
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
792 highlighting: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
793 :hi link cConstant NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
794
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
795 If you see '{' and '}' highlighted as an error where they are OK, reset the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
796 highlighting for cErrInParen and cErrInBracket.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
797
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
798 If you want to use folding in your C files, you can add these lines in a file
2207
b17bbfa96fa0 Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
799 in the "after" directory in 'runtimepath'. For Unix this would be
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
800 ~/.vim/after/syntax/c.vim. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
801 syn sync fromstart
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
802 set foldmethod=syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
803
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
804 CH *ch.vim* *ft-ch-syntax*
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
805
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
806 C/C++ interpreter. Ch has similar syntax highlighting to C and builds upon
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
807 the C syntax file. See |c.vim| for all the settings that are available for C.
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
808
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
809 By setting a variable you can tell Vim to use Ch syntax for *.h files, instead
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
810 of C or C++: >
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
811 :let ch_syntax_for_h = 1
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
812
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
813
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
814 CHILL *chill.vim* *ft-chill-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
815
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
816 Chill syntax highlighting is similar to C. See |c.vim| for all the settings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
817 that are available. Additionally there is:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
818
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
819 chill_space_errors like c_space_errors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
820 chill_comment_string like c_comment_strings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
821 chill_minlines like c_minlines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
822
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
823
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
824 CHANGELOG *changelog.vim* *ft-changelog-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
825
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
826 ChangeLog supports highlighting spaces at the start of a line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
827 If you do not like this, add following line to your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
828 let g:changelog_spacing_errors = 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
829 This works the next time you edit a changelog file. You can also use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
830 "b:changelog_spacing_errors" to set this per buffer (before loading the syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
831 file).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
832
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
833 You can change the highlighting used, e.g., to flag the spaces as an error: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
834 :hi link ChangelogError Error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
835 Or to avoid the highlighting: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
836 :hi link ChangelogError NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
837 This works immediately.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
838
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
839
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
840 COBOL *cobol.vim* *ft-cobol-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
841
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
842 COBOL highlighting has different needs for legacy code than it does for fresh
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
843 development. This is due to differences in what is being done (maintenance
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
844 versus development) and other factors. To enable legacy code highlighting,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
845 add this line to your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
846 :let cobol_legacy_code = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
847 To disable it again, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
848 :unlet cobol_legacy_code
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
849
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
850
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
851 COLD FUSION *coldfusion.vim* *ft-coldfusion-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
852
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
853 The ColdFusion has its own version of HTML comments. To turn on ColdFusion
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
854 comment highlighting, add the following line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
855
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
856 :let html_wrong_comments = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
857
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
858 The ColdFusion syntax file is based on the HTML syntax file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
859
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
860
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
861 CSH *csh.vim* *ft-csh-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
862
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
863 This covers the shell named "csh". Note that on some systems tcsh is actually
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
864 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
865
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
866 Detecting whether a file is csh or tcsh is notoriously hard. Some systems
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
867 symlink /bin/csh to /bin/tcsh, making it almost impossible to distinguish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
868 between csh and tcsh. In case VIM guesses wrong you can set the
2965
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
869 "filetype_csh" variable. For using csh: *g:filetype_csh*
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
870 >
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
871 :let g:filetype_csh = "csh"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
872
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
873 For using tcsh: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
874
2965
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
875 :let g:filetype_csh = "tcsh"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
876
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
877 Any script with a tcsh extension or a standard tcsh filename (.tcshrc,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
878 tcsh.tcshrc, tcsh.login) will have filetype tcsh. All other tcsh/csh scripts
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
879 will be classified as tcsh, UNLESS the "filetype_csh" variable exists. If the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
880 "filetype_csh" variable exists, the filetype will be set to the value of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
881 variable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
882
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
883
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
884 CYNLIB *cynlib.vim* *ft-cynlib-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
885
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
886 Cynlib files are C++ files that use the Cynlib class library to enable
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
887 hardware modelling and simulation using C++. Typically Cynlib files have a .cc
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
888 or a .cpp extension, which makes it very difficult to distinguish them from a
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
889 normal C++ file. Thus, to enable Cynlib highlighting for .cc files, add this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
890 line to your .vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
891
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
892 :let cynlib_cyntax_for_cc=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
893
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
894 Similarly for cpp files (this extension is only usually used in Windows) >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
895
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
896 :let cynlib_cyntax_for_cpp=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
897
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
898 To disable these again, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
899
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
900 :unlet cynlib_cyntax_for_cc
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
901 :unlet cynlib_cyntax_for_cpp
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
902 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
903
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
904 CWEB *cweb.vim* *ft-cweb-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
905
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
906 Files matching "*.w" could be Progress or cweb. If the automatic detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
907 doesn't work for you, or you don't edit Progress at all, use this in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
908 startup vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
909 :let filetype_w = "cweb"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
910
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
911
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
912 DESKTOP *desktop.vim* *ft-desktop-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
913
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
914 Primary goal of this syntax file is to highlight .desktop and .directory files
2236
dc2e5ec0500d Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
915 according to freedesktop.org standard:
dc2e5ec0500d Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
916 http://standards.freedesktop.org/desktop-entry-spec/latest/
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
917 But actually almost none implements this standard fully. Thus it will
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
918 highlight all Unix ini files. But you can force strict highlighting according
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
919 to standard by placing this in your vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
920 :let enforce_freedesktop_standard = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
921
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
922
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
923 DIRCOLORS *dircolors.vim* *ft-dircolors-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
924
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
925 The dircolors utility highlighting definition has one option. It exists to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
926 provide compatibility with the Slackware GNU/Linux distributions version of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
927 the command. It adds a few keywords that are generally ignored by most
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
928 versions. On Slackware systems, however, the utility accepts the keywords and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
929 uses them for processing. To enable the Slackware keywords add the following
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
930 line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
931 let dircolors_is_slackware = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
932
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
933
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
934 DOCBOOK *docbk.vim* *ft-docbk-syntax* *docbook*
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
935 DOCBOOK XML *docbkxml.vim* *ft-docbkxml-syntax*
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
936 DOCBOOK SGML *docbksgml.vim* *ft-docbksgml-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
937
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
938 There are two types of DocBook files: SGML and XML. To specify what type you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
939 are using the "b:docbk_type" variable should be set. Vim does this for you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
940 automatically if it can recognize the type. When Vim can't guess it the type
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
941 defaults to XML.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
942 You can set the type manually: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
943 :let docbk_type = "sgml"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
944 or: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
945 :let docbk_type = "xml"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
946 You need to do this before loading the syntax file, which is complicated.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
947 Simpler is setting the filetype to "docbkxml" or "docbksgml": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
948 :set filetype=docbksgml
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
949 or: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
950 :set filetype=docbkxml
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
951
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
952
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
953 DOSBATCH *dosbatch.vim* *ft-dosbatch-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
954
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
955 There is one option with highlighting DOS batch files. This covers new
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
956 extensions to the Command Interpreter introduced with Windows 2000 and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
957 is controlled by the variable dosbatch_cmdextversion. For Windows NT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
958 this should have the value 1, and for Windows 2000 it should be 2.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
959 Select the version you want with the following line: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
960
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
961 :let dosbatch_cmdextversion = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
962
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
963 If this variable is not defined it defaults to a value of 2 to support
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
964 Windows 2000.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
965
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
966 A second option covers whether *.btm files should be detected as type
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
967 "dosbatch" (MS-DOS batch files) or type "btm" (4DOS batch files). The latter
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
968 is used by default. You may select the former with the following line: >
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
969
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
970 :let g:dosbatch_syntax_for_btm = 1
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
971
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
972 If this variable is undefined or zero, btm syntax is selected.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
973
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
974
832
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
975 DOXYGEN *doxygen.vim* *doxygen-syntax*
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
976
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
977 Doxygen generates code documentation using a special documentation format
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
978 (similar to Javadoc). This syntax script adds doxygen highlighting to c, cpp,
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
979 idl and php files, and should also work with java.
832
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
980
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
981 There are a few of ways to turn on doxygen formatting. It can be done
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
982 explicitly or in a modeline by appending '.doxygen' to the syntax of the file.
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
983 Example: >
832
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
984 :set syntax=c.doxygen
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
985 or >
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
986 // vim:syntax=c.doxygen
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
987
2520
6768ebd0bc04 Remove unused code.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2496
diff changeset
988 It can also be done automatically for C, C++, C# and IDL files by setting the
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
989 global or buffer-local variable load_doxygen_syntax. This is done by adding
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
990 the following to your .vimrc. >
832
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
991 :let g:load_doxygen_syntax=1
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
992
2207
b17bbfa96fa0 Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
993 There are a couple of variables that have an effect on syntax highlighting, and
832
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
994 are to do with non-standard highlighting options.
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
995
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
996 Variable Default Effect ~
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
997 g:doxygen_enhanced_color
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
998 g:doxygen_enhanced_colour 0 Use non-standard highlighting for
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
999 doxygen comments.
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1000
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1001 doxygen_my_rendering 0 Disable rendering of HTML bold, italic
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1002 and html_my_rendering underline.
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1003
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1004 doxygen_javadoc_autobrief 1 Set to 0 to disable javadoc autobrief
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1005 colour highlighting.
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1006
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1007 doxygen_end_punctuation '[.]' Set to regexp match for the ending
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
1008 punctuation of brief
832
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1009
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1010 There are also some hilight groups worth mentioning as they can be useful in
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1011 configuration.
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1012
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1013 Highlight Effect ~
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1014 doxygenErrorComment The colour of an end-comment when missing
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1015 punctuation in a code, verbatim or dot section
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1016 doxygenLinkError The colour of an end-comment when missing the
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1017 \endlink from a \link section.
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1018
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1019
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1020 DTD *dtd.vim* *ft-dtd-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1021
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1022 The DTD syntax highlighting is case sensitive by default. To disable
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1023 case-sensitive highlighting, add the following line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1024
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1025 :let dtd_ignore_case=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1026
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1027 The DTD syntax file will highlight unknown tags as errors. If
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1028 this is annoying, it can be turned off by setting: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1029
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1030 :let dtd_no_tag_errors=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1031
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1032 before sourcing the dtd.vim syntax file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1033 Parameter entity names are highlighted in the definition using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1034 'Type' highlighting group and 'Comment' for punctuation and '%'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1035 Parameter entity instances are highlighted using the 'Constant'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1036 highlighting group and the 'Type' highlighting group for the
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1037 delimiters % and ;. This can be turned off by setting: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1038
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1039 :let dtd_no_param_entities=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1040
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1041 The DTD syntax file is also included by xml.vim to highlight included dtd's.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1042
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1043
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1044 EIFFEL *eiffel.vim* *ft-eiffel-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1045
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1046 While Eiffel is not case-sensitive, its style guidelines are, and the
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1047 syntax highlighting file encourages their use. This also allows to
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1048 highlight class names differently. If you want to disable case-sensitive
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1049 highlighting, add the following line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1050
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1051 :let eiffel_ignore_case=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1052
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1053 Case still matters for class names and TODO marks in comments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1054
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1055 Conversely, for even stricter checks, add one of the following lines: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1056
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1057 :let eiffel_strict=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1058 :let eiffel_pedantic=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1059
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1060 Setting eiffel_strict will only catch improper capitalization for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1061 five predefined words "Current", "Void", "Result", "Precursor", and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1062 "NONE", to warn against their accidental use as feature or class names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1063
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1064 Setting eiffel_pedantic will enforce adherence to the Eiffel style
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1065 guidelines fairly rigorously (like arbitrary mixes of upper- and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1066 lowercase letters as well as outdated ways to capitalize keywords).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1067
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1068 If you want to use the lower-case version of "Current", "Void",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1069 "Result", and "Precursor", you can use >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1070
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1071 :let eiffel_lower_case_predef=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1072
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1073 instead of completely turning case-sensitive highlighting off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1074
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1075 Support for ISE's proposed new creation syntax that is already
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1076 experimentally handled by some compilers can be enabled by: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1077
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1078 :let eiffel_ise=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1079
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1080 Finally, some vendors support hexadecimal constants. To handle them, add >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1081
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1082 :let eiffel_hex_constants=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1083
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1084 to your startup file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1085
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1086
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1087 ERLANG *erlang.vim* *ft-erlang-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1088
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1089 The erlang highlighting supports Erlang (ERicsson LANGuage).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1090 Erlang is case sensitive and default extension is ".erl".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1091
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1092 If you want to disable keywords highlighting, put in your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1093 :let erlang_keywords = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1094 If you want to disable built-in-functions highlighting, put in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1095 .vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1096 :let erlang_functions = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1097 If you want to disable special characters highlighting, put in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1098 your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1099 :let erlang_characters = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1101
857
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1102 FLEXWIKI *flexwiki.vim* *ft-flexwiki-syntax*
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1103
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1104 FlexWiki is an ASP.NET-based wiki package available at http://www.flexwiki.com
2826
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
1105 NOTE: this site currently doesn't work, on Wikipedia is mentioned that
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
1106 development stopped in 2009.
857
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1107
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1108 Syntax highlighting is available for the most common elements of FlexWiki
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1109 syntax. The associated ftplugin script sets some buffer-local options to make
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1110 editing FlexWiki pages more convenient. FlexWiki considers a newline as the
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1111 start of a new paragraph, so the ftplugin sets 'tw'=0 (unlimited line length),
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1112 'wrap' (wrap long lines instead of using horizontal scrolling), 'linebreak'
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1113 (to wrap at a character in 'breakat' instead of at the last char on screen),
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1114 and so on. It also includes some keymaps that are disabled by default.
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1115
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1116 If you want to enable the keymaps that make "j" and "k" and the cursor keys
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1117 move up and down by display lines, add this to your .vimrc: >
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1118 :let flexwiki_maps = 1
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1119
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1120
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1121 FORM *form.vim* *ft-form-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1122
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1123 The coloring scheme for syntax elements in the FORM file uses the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1124 modes Conditional, Number, Statement, Comment, PreProc, Type, and String,
1275
d787f6c4c481 updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1224
diff changeset
1125 following the language specifications in 'Symbolic Manipulation with FORM' by
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1126 J.A.M. Vermaseren, CAN, Netherlands, 1991.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1127
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1128 If you want include your own changes to the default colors, you have to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1129 redefine the following syntax groups:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1130
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1131 - formConditional
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1132 - formNumber
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1133 - formStatement
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1134 - formHeaderStatement
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1135 - formComment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1136 - formPreProc
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1137 - formDirective
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1138 - formType
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1139 - formString
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1140
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1141 Note that the form.vim syntax file implements FORM preprocessor commands and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1142 directives per default in the same syntax group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1143
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1144 A predefined enhanced color mode for FORM is available to distinguish between
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1145 header statements and statements in the body of a FORM program. To activate
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1146 this mode define the following variable in your vimrc file >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1147
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1148 :let form_enhanced_color=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1149
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1150 The enhanced mode also takes advantage of additional color features for a dark
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1151 gvim display. Here, statements are colored LightYellow instead of Yellow, and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1152 conditionals are LightBlue for better distinction.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1153
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1154
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1155 FORTRAN *fortran.vim* *ft-fortran-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1156
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1157 Default highlighting and dialect ~
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1158 Highlighting appropriate for f95 (Fortran 95) is used by default. This choice
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1159 should be appropriate for most users most of the time because Fortran 95 is a
2398
0c8219a26bc9 More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2386
diff changeset
1160 superset of Fortran 90 and almost a superset of Fortran 77. Support for
0c8219a26bc9 More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2386
diff changeset
1161 Fortran 2003 and Fortran 2008 features has been introduced and is
2370
454f314d0e61 Make it possible to load Perl dynamically on Unix. (James Vega)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2365
diff changeset
1162 automatically available in the default (f95) highlighting.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1163
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1164 Fortran source code form ~
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1165 Fortran 9x code can be in either fixed or free source form. Note that the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1166 syntax highlighting will not be correct if the form is incorrectly set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1167
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1168 When you create a new fortran file, the syntax script assumes fixed source
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1169 form. If you always use free source form, then >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1170 :let fortran_free_source=1
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1171 in your .vimrc prior to the :syntax on command. If you always use fixed source
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1172 form, then >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1173 :let fortran_fixed_source=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1174 in your .vimrc prior to the :syntax on command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1175
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1176 If the form of the source code depends upon the file extension, then it is
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1177 most convenient to set fortran_free_source in a ftplugin file. For more
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1178 information on ftplugin files, see |ftplugin|. For example, if all your
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1179 fortran files with an .f90 extension are written in free source form and the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1180 rest in fixed source form, add the following code to your ftplugin file >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1181 let s:extfname = expand("%:e")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1182 if s:extfname ==? "f90"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1183 let fortran_free_source=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1184 unlet! fortran_fixed_source
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1185 else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1186 let fortran_fixed_source=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1187 unlet! fortran_free_source
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1188 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1189 Note that this will work only if the "filetype plugin indent on" command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1190 precedes the "syntax on" command in your .vimrc file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1191
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1192 When you edit an existing fortran file, the syntax script will assume free
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1193 source form if the fortran_free_source variable has been set, and assumes
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1194 fixed source form if the fortran_fixed_source variable has been set. If
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1195 neither of these variables have been set, the syntax script attempts to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1196 determine which source form has been used by examining the first five columns
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
1197 of the first 250 lines of your file. If no signs of free source form are
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1198 detected, then the file is assumed to be in fixed source form. The algorithm
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1199 should work in the vast majority of cases. In some cases, such as a file that
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
1200 begins with 250 or more full-line comments, the script may incorrectly decide
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1201 that the fortran code is in fixed form. If that happens, just add a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1202 non-comment statement beginning anywhere in the first five columns of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1203 first twenty five lines, save (:w) and then reload (:e!) the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1204
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1205 Tabs in fortran files ~
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1206 Tabs are not recognized by the Fortran standards. Tabs are not a good idea in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1207 fixed format fortran source code which requires fixed column boundaries.
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1208 Therefore, tabs are marked as errors. Nevertheless, some programmers like
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1209 using tabs. If your fortran files contain tabs, then you should set the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1210 variable fortran_have_tabs in your .vimrc with a command such as >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1211 :let fortran_have_tabs=1
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1212 placed prior to the :syntax on command. Unfortunately, the use of tabs will
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1213 mean that the syntax file will not be able to detect incorrect margins.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1214
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1215 Syntax folding of fortran files ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1216 If you wish to use foldmethod=syntax, then you must first set the variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1217 fortran_fold with a command such as >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1218 :let fortran_fold=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1219 to instruct the syntax script to define fold regions for program units, that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1220 is main programs starting with a program statement, subroutines, function
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1221 subprograms, block data subprograms, interface blocks, and modules. If you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1222 also set the variable fortran_fold_conditionals with a command such as >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1223 :let fortran_fold_conditionals=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1224 then fold regions will also be defined for do loops, if blocks, and select
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1225 case constructs. If you also set the variable
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1226 fortran_fold_multilinecomments with a command such as >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1227 :let fortran_fold_multilinecomments=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1228 then fold regions will also be defined for three or more consecutive comment
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1229 lines. Note that defining fold regions can be slow for large files.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1230
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1231 If fortran_fold, and possibly fortran_fold_conditionals and/or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1232 fortran_fold_multilinecomments, have been set, then vim will fold your file if
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1233 you set foldmethod=syntax. Comments or blank lines placed between two program
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1234 units are not folded because they are seen as not belonging to any program
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1235 unit.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1236
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1237 More precise fortran syntax ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1238 If you set the variable fortran_more_precise with a command such as >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1239 :let fortran_more_precise=1
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1240 then the syntax coloring will be more precise but slower. In particular,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1241 statement labels used in do, goto and arithmetic if statements will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1242 recognized, as will construct names at the end of a do, if, select or forall
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1243 construct.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1244
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1245 Non-default fortran dialects ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1246 The syntax script supports five Fortran dialects: f95, f90, f77, the Lahey
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1247 subset elf90, and the Imagine1 subset F.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1248
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1249 If you use f77 with extensions, even common ones like do/enddo loops, do/while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1250 loops and free source form that are supported by most f77 compilers including
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1251 g77 (GNU Fortran), then you will probably find the default highlighting
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1252 satisfactory. However, if you use strict f77 with no extensions, not even free
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1253 source form or the MIL STD 1753 extensions, then the advantages of setting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1254 dialect to f77 are that names such as SUM are recognized as user variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1255 names and not highlighted as f9x intrinsic functions, that obsolete constructs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1256 such as ASSIGN statements are not highlighted as todo items, and that fixed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1257 source form will be assumed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1258
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1259 If you use elf90 or F, the advantage of setting the dialect appropriately is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1260 that f90 features excluded from these dialects will be highlighted as todo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1261 items and that free source form will be assumed as required for these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1262 dialects.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1263
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1264 The dialect can be selected by setting the variable fortran_dialect. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1265 permissible values of fortran_dialect are case-sensitive and must be "f95",
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1266 "f90", "f77", "elf" or "F". Invalid values of fortran_dialect are ignored.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1267
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1268 If all your fortran files use the same dialect, set fortran_dialect in your
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1269 .vimrc prior to your syntax on statement. If the dialect depends upon the file
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1270 extension, then it is most convenient to set it in a ftplugin file. For more
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1271 information on ftplugin files, see |ftplugin|. For example, if all your
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1272 fortran files with an .f90 extension are written in the elf subset, your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1273 ftplugin file should contain the code >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1274 let s:extfname = expand("%:e")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1275 if s:extfname ==? "f90"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1276 let fortran_dialect="elf"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1277 else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1278 unlet! fortran_dialect
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1279 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1280 Note that this will work only if the "filetype plugin indent on" command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1281 precedes the "syntax on" command in your .vimrc file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1282
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1283 Finer control is necessary if the file extension does not uniquely identify
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1284 the dialect. You can override the default dialect, on a file-by-file basis, by
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1285 including a comment with the directive "fortran_dialect=xx" (where xx=f77 or
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1286 elf or F or f90 or f95) in one of the first three lines in your file. For
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1287 example, your older .f files may be written in extended f77 but your newer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1288 ones may be F codes, and you would identify the latter by including in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1289 first three lines of those files a Fortran comment of the form >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1290 ! fortran_dialect=F
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1291 F overrides elf if both directives are present.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1292
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1293 Limitations ~
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1294 Parenthesis checking does not catch too few closing parentheses. Hollerith
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1295 strings are not recognized. Some keywords may be highlighted incorrectly
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1296 because Fortran90 has no reserved words.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1297
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1298 For further information related to fortran, see |ft-fortran-indent| and
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1299 |ft-fortran-plugin|.
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1300
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1301
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1302 FVWM CONFIGURATION FILES *fvwm.vim* *ft-fvwm-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1303
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1304 In order for Vim to recognize Fvwm configuration files that do not match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1305 the patterns *fvwmrc* or *fvwm2rc* , you must put additional patterns
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1306 appropriate to your system in your myfiletypes.vim file. For these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1307 patterns, you must set the variable "b:fvwm_version" to the major version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1308 number of Fvwm, and the 'filetype' option to fvwm.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1309
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1310 For example, to make Vim identify all files in /etc/X11/fvwm2/
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1311 as Fvwm2 configuration files, add the following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1312
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1313 :au! BufNewFile,BufRead /etc/X11/fvwm2/* let b:fvwm_version = 2 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1314 \ set filetype=fvwm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1315
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1316 If you'd like Vim to highlight all valid color names, tell it where to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1317 find the color database (rgb.txt) on your system. Do this by setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1318 "rgb_file" to its location. Assuming your color database is located
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1319 in /usr/X11/lib/X11/, you should add the line >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1320
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1321 :let rgb_file = "/usr/X11/lib/X11/rgb.txt"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1322
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1323 to your .vimrc file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1324
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1325
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1326 GSP *gsp.vim* *ft-gsp-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1327
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1328 The default coloring style for GSP pages is defined by |html.vim|, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1329 the coloring for java code (within java tags or inline between backticks)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1330 is defined by |java.vim|. The following HTML groups defined in |html.vim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1331 are redefined to incorporate and highlight inline java code:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1332
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1333 htmlString
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1334 htmlValue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1335 htmlEndTag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1336 htmlTag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1337 htmlTagN
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1338
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1339 Highlighting should look fine most of the places where you'd see inline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1340 java code, but in some special cases it may not. To add another HTML
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1341 group where you will have inline java code where it does not highlight
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1342 correctly, just copy the line you want from |html.vim| and add gspJava
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1343 to the contains clause.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1344
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1345 The backticks for inline java are highlighted according to the htmlError
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1346 group to make them easier to see.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1347
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1348
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1349 GROFF *groff.vim* *ft-groff-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1350
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1351 The groff syntax file is a wrapper for |nroff.vim|, see the notes
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1352 under that heading for examples of use and configuration. The purpose
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1353 of this wrapper is to set up groff syntax extensions by setting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1354 filetype from a |modeline| or in a personal filetype definitions file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1355 (see |filetype.txt|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1356
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1357
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1358 HASKELL *haskell.vim* *lhaskell.vim* *ft-haskell-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1359
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1360 The Haskell syntax files support plain Haskell code as well as literate
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1361 Haskell code, the latter in both Bird style and TeX style. The Haskell
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1362 syntax highlighting will also highlight C preprocessor directives.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1363
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1364 If you want to highlight delimiter characters (useful if you have a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1365 light-coloured background), add to your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1366 :let hs_highlight_delimiters = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1367 To treat True and False as keywords as opposed to ordinary identifiers,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1368 add: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1369 :let hs_highlight_boolean = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1370 To also treat the names of primitive types as keywords: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1371 :let hs_highlight_types = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1372 And to treat the names of even more relatively common types as keywords: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1373 :let hs_highlight_more_types = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1374 If you want to highlight the names of debugging functions, put in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1375 your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1376 :let hs_highlight_debug = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1377
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1378 The Haskell syntax highlighting also highlights C preprocessor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1379 directives, and flags lines that start with # but are not valid
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1380 directives as erroneous. This interferes with Haskell's syntax for
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1381 operators, as they may start with #. If you want to highlight those
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1382 as operators as opposed to errors, put in your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1383 :let hs_allow_hash_operator = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1384
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1385 The syntax highlighting for literate Haskell code will try to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1386 automatically guess whether your literate Haskell code contains
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1387 TeX markup or not, and correspondingly highlight TeX constructs
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1388 or nothing at all. You can override this globally by putting
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1389 in your .vimrc >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1390 :let lhs_markup = none
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1391 for no highlighting at all, or >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1392 :let lhs_markup = tex
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1393 to force the highlighting to always try to highlight TeX markup.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1394 For more flexibility, you may also use buffer local versions of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1395 this variable, so e.g. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1396 :let b:lhs_markup = tex
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1397 will force TeX highlighting for a particular buffer. It has to be
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1398 set before turning syntax highlighting on for the buffer or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1399 loading a file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1400
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1401
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1402 HTML *html.vim* *ft-html-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1403
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1404 The coloring scheme for tags in the HTML file works as follows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1405
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1406 The <> of opening tags are colored differently than the </> of a closing tag.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1407 This is on purpose! For opening tags the 'Function' color is used, while for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1408 closing tags the 'Type' color is used (See syntax.vim to check how those are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1409 defined for you)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1410
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1411 Known tag names are colored the same way as statements in C. Unknown tag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1412 names are colored with the same color as the <> or </> respectively which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1413 makes it easy to spot errors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1414
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1415 Note that the same is true for argument (or attribute) names. Known attribute
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1416 names are colored differently than unknown ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1417
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1418 Some HTML tags are used to change the rendering of text. The following tags
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1419 are recognized by the html.vim syntax coloring file and change the way normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1420 text is shown: <B> <I> <U> <EM> <STRONG> (<EM> is used as an alias for <I>,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1421 while <STRONG> as an alias for <B>), <H1> - <H6>, <HEAD>, <TITLE> and <A>, but
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1422 only if used as a link (that is, it must include a href as in
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
1423 <A href="somefile.html">).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1424
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1425 If you want to change how such text is rendered, you must redefine the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1426 following syntax groups:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1427
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1428 - htmlBold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1429 - htmlBoldUnderline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1430 - htmlBoldUnderlineItalic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1431 - htmlUnderline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1432 - htmlUnderlineItalic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1433 - htmlItalic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1434 - htmlTitle for titles
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1435 - htmlH1 - htmlH6 for headings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1436
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1437 To make this redefinition work you must redefine them all with the exception
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1438 of the last two (htmlTitle and htmlH[1-6], which are optional) and define the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1439 following variable in your vimrc (this is due to the order in which the files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1440 are read during initialization) >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1441 :let html_my_rendering=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1442
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1443 If you'd like to see an example download mysyntax.vim at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1444 http://www.fleiner.com/vim/download.html
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1445
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1446 You can also disable this rendering by adding the following line to your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1447 vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1448 :let html_no_rendering=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1449
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1450 HTML comments are rather special (see an HTML reference document for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1451 details), and the syntax coloring scheme will highlight all errors.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1452 However, if you prefer to use the wrong style (starts with <!-- and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1453 ends with --!>) you can define >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1454 :let html_wrong_comments=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1455
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1456 JavaScript and Visual Basic embedded inside HTML documents are highlighted as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1457 'Special' with statements, comments, strings and so on colored as in standard
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1458 programming languages. Note that only JavaScript and Visual Basic are currently
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1459 supported, no other scripting language has been added yet.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1460
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1461 Embedded and inlined cascading style sheets (CSS) are highlighted too.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1462
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1463 There are several html preprocessor languages out there. html.vim has been
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1464 written such that it should be trivial to include it. To do so add the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1465 following two lines to the syntax coloring file for that language
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1466 (the example comes from the asp.vim file):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1467
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1468 runtime! syntax/html.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1469 syn cluster htmlPreproc add=asp
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1470
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1471 Now you just need to make sure that you add all regions that contain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1472 the preprocessor language to the cluster htmlPreproc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1473
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1474
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1475 HTML/OS (by Aestiva) *htmlos.vim* *ft-htmlos-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1476
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1477 The coloring scheme for HTML/OS works as follows:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1478
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1479 Functions and variable names are the same color by default, because VIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1480 doesn't specify different colors for Functions and Identifiers. To change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1481 this (which is recommended if you want function names to be recognizable in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1482 different color) you need to add the following line to either your ~/.vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1483 :hi Function term=underline cterm=bold ctermfg=LightGray
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1484
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1485 Of course, the ctermfg can be a different color if you choose.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1486
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1487 Another issues that HTML/OS runs into is that there is no special filetype to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1488 signify that it is a file with HTML/OS coding. You can change this by opening
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1489 a file and turning on HTML/OS syntax by doing the following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1490 :set syntax=htmlos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1491
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1492 Lastly, it should be noted that the opening and closing characters to begin a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1493 block of HTML/OS code can either be << or [[ and >> or ]], respectively.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1494
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1495
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1496 IA64 *ia64.vim* *intel-itanium* *ft-ia64-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1497
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1498 Highlighting for the Intel Itanium 64 assembly language. See |asm.vim| for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1499 how to recognize this filetype.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1500
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1501 To have *.inc files be recognized as IA64, add this to your .vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1502 :let g:filetype_inc = "ia64"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1503
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1504
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1505 INFORM *inform.vim* *ft-inform-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1506
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1507 Inform highlighting includes symbols provided by the Inform Library, as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1508 most programs make extensive use of it. If do not wish Library symbols
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1509 to be highlighted add this to your vim startup: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1510 :let inform_highlight_simple=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1511
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1512 By default it is assumed that Inform programs are Z-machine targeted,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1513 and highlights Z-machine assembly language symbols appropriately. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1514 you intend your program to be targeted to a Glulx/Glk environment you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1515 need to add this to your startup sequence: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1516 :let inform_highlight_glulx=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1517
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1518 This will highlight Glulx opcodes instead, and also adds glk() to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1519 set of highlighted system functions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1520
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1521 The Inform compiler will flag certain obsolete keywords as errors when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1522 it encounters them. These keywords are normally highlighted as errors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1523 by Vim. To prevent such error highlighting, you must add this to your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1524 startup sequence: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1525 :let inform_suppress_obsolete=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1526
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1527 By default, the language features highlighted conform to Compiler
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1528 version 6.30 and Library version 6.11. If you are using an older
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1529 Inform development environment, you may with to add this to your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1530 startup sequence: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1531 :let inform_highlight_old=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1532
829
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1533 IDL *idl.vim* *idl-syntax*
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1534
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1535 IDL (Interface Definition Language) files are used to define RPC calls. In
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1536 Microsoft land, this is also used for defining COM interfaces and calls.
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1537
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1538 IDL's structure is simple enough to permit a full grammar based approach to
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1539 rather than using a few heuristics. The result is large and somewhat
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
1540 repetitive but seems to work.
829
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1541
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1542 There are some Microsoft extensions to idl files that are here. Some of them
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1543 are disabled by defining idl_no_ms_extensions.
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1544
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1545 The more complex of the extensions are disabled by defining idl_no_extensions.
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1546
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1547 Variable Effect ~
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1548
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1549 idl_no_ms_extensions Disable some of the Microsoft specific
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1550 extensions
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1551 idl_no_extensions Disable complex extensions
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1552 idlsyntax_showerror Show IDL errors (can be rather intrusive, but
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1553 quite helpful)
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1554 idlsyntax_showerror_soft Use softer colours by default for errors
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1555
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1556
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1557 JAVA *java.vim* *ft-java-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1558
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1559 The java.vim syntax highlighting file offers several options:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1560
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1561 In Java 1.0.2 it was never possible to have braces inside parens, so this was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1562 flagged as an error. Since Java 1.1 this is possible (with anonymous
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1563 classes), and therefore is no longer marked as an error. If you prefer the old
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1564 way, put the following line into your vim startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1565 :let java_mark_braces_in_parens_as_errors=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1566
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1567 All identifiers in java.lang.* are always visible in all classes. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1568 highlight them use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1569 :let java_highlight_java_lang_ids=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1570
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1571 You can also highlight identifiers of most standard Java packages if you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1572 download the javaid.vim script at http://www.fleiner.com/vim/download.html.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1573 If you prefer to only highlight identifiers of a certain package, say java.io
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1574 use the following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1575 :let java_highlight_java_io=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1576 Check the javaid.vim file for a list of all the packages that are supported.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1577
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1578 Function names are not highlighted, as the way to find functions depends on
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1579 how you write Java code. The syntax file knows two possible ways to highlight
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1580 functions:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1581
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1582 If you write function declarations that are always indented by either
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1583 a tab, 8 spaces or 2 spaces you may want to set >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1584 :let java_highlight_functions="indent"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1585 However, if you follow the Java guidelines about how functions and classes are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1586 supposed to be named (with respect to upper and lowercase), use >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1587 :let java_highlight_functions="style"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1588 If both options do not work for you, but you would still want function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1589 declarations to be highlighted create your own definitions by changing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1590 definitions in java.vim or by creating your own java.vim which includes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1591 original one and then adds the code to highlight functions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1592
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1593 In Java 1.1 the functions System.out.println() and System.err.println() should
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
1594 only be used for debugging. Therefore it is possible to highlight debugging
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1595 statements differently. To do this you must add the following definition in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1596 your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1597 :let java_highlight_debug=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1598 The result will be that those statements are highlighted as 'Special'
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1599 characters. If you prefer to have them highlighted differently you must define
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1600 new highlightings for the following groups.:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1601 Debug, DebugSpecial, DebugString, DebugBoolean, DebugType
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1602 which are used for the statement itself, special characters used in debug
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1603 strings, strings, boolean constants and types (this, super) respectively. I
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1604 have opted to chose another background for those statements.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1605
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
1606 In order to help you write code that can be easily ported between Java and
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
1607 C++, all C++ keywords can be marked as an error in a Java program. To
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
1608 have this add this line in your .vimrc file: >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
1609 :let java_allow_cpp_keywords = 0
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1610
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1611 Javadoc is a program that takes special comments out of Java program files and
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1612 creates HTML pages. The standard configuration will highlight this HTML code
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1613 similarly to HTML files (see |html.vim|). You can even add Javascript
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1614 and CSS inside this code (see below). There are four differences however:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1615 1. The title (all characters up to the first '.' which is followed by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1616 some white space or up to the first '@') is colored differently (to change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1617 the color change the group CommentTitle).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1618 2. The text is colored as 'Comment'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1619 3. HTML comments are colored as 'Special'
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1620 4. The special Javadoc tags (@see, @param, ...) are highlighted as specials
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1621 and the argument (for @see, @param, @exception) as Function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1622 To turn this feature off add the following line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1623 :let java_ignore_javadoc=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1624
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1625 If you use the special Javadoc comment highlighting described above you
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1626 can also turn on special highlighting for Javascript, visual basic
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1627 scripts and embedded CSS (stylesheets). This makes only sense if you
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1628 actually have Javadoc comments that include either Javascript or embedded
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1629 CSS. The options to use are >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1630 :let java_javascript=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1631 :let java_css=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1632 :let java_vb=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1633
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1634 In order to highlight nested parens with different colors define colors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1635 for javaParen, javaParen1 and javaParen2, for example with >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1636 :hi link javaParen Comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1637 or >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1638 :hi javaParen ctermfg=blue guifg=#0000ff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1639
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1640 If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards, which are fixed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1641 when redrawing with CTRL-L, try setting the "java_minlines" internal variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1642 to a larger number: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1643 :let java_minlines = 50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1644 This will make the syntax synchronization start 50 lines before the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1645 displayed line. The default value is 10. The disadvantage of using a larger
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1646 number is that redrawing can become slow.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1647
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1648
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1649 LACE *lace.vim* *ft-lace-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1650
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1651 Lace (Language for Assembly of Classes in Eiffel) is case insensitive, but the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1652 style guide lines are not. If you prefer case insensitive highlighting, just
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1653 define the vim variable 'lace_case_insensitive' in your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1654 :let lace_case_insensitive=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1655
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1656
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1657 LEX *lex.vim* *ft-lex-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1658
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1659 Lex uses brute-force synchronizing as the "^%%$" section delimiter
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1660 gives no clue as to what section follows. Consequently, the value for >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1661 :syn sync minlines=300
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1662 may be changed by the user if s/he is experiencing synchronization
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1663 difficulties (such as may happen with large lex files).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1664
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1665
2412
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1666 LIFELINES *lifelines.vim* *ft-lifelines-syntax*
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1667
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1668 To highlight deprecated functions as errors, add in your .vimrc: >
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1669
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1670 :let g:lifelines_deprecated = 1
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1671 <
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1672
555
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1673 LISP *lisp.vim* *ft-lisp-syntax*
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1674
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1675 The lisp syntax highlighting provides two options: >
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1676
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1677 g:lisp_instring : if it exists, then "(...)" strings are highlighted
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1678 as if the contents of the string were lisp.
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1679 Useful for AutoLisp.
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1680 g:lisp_rainbow : if it exists and is nonzero, then differing levels
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1681 of parenthesization will receive different
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1682 highlighting.
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1683 <
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1684 The g:lisp_rainbow option provides 10 levels of individual colorization for
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1685 the parentheses and backquoted parentheses. Because of the quantity of
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1686 colorization levels, unlike non-rainbow highlighting, the rainbow mode
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1687 specifies its highlighting using ctermfg and guifg, thereby bypassing the
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1688 usual colorscheme control using standard highlighting groups. The actual
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1689 highlighting used depends on the dark/bright setting (see |'bg'|).
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1690
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1691
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1692 LITE *lite.vim* *ft-lite-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1693
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1694 There are two options for the lite syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1695
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1696 If you like SQL syntax highlighting inside Strings, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1697
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1698 :let lite_sql_query = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1699
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1700 For syncing, minlines defaults to 100. If you prefer another value, you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1701 set "lite_minlines" to the value you desire. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1702
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1703 :let lite_minlines = 200
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1704
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1705
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1706 LPC *lpc.vim* *ft-lpc-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1707
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1708 LPC stands for a simple, memory-efficient language: Lars Pensj| C. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1709 file name of LPC is usually *.c. Recognizing these files as LPC would bother
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1710 users writing only C programs. If you want to use LPC syntax in Vim, you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1711 should set a variable in your .vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1712
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1713 :let lpc_syntax_for_c = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1714
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1715 If it doesn't work properly for some particular C or LPC files, use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1716 modeline. For a LPC file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1717
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1718 // vim:set ft=lpc:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1719
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1720 For a C file that is recognized as LPC:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1721
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1722 // vim:set ft=c:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1723
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1724 If you don't want to set the variable, use the modeline in EVERY LPC file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1725
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1726 There are several implementations for LPC, we intend to support most widely
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1727 used ones. Here the default LPC syntax is for MudOS series, for MudOS v22
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1728 and before, you should turn off the sensible modifiers, and this will also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1729 asserts the new efuns after v22 to be invalid, don't set this variable when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1730 you are using the latest version of MudOS: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1731
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1732 :let lpc_pre_v22 = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1733
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1734 For LpMud 3.2 series of LPC: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1735
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1736 :let lpc_compat_32 = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1737
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1738 For LPC4 series of LPC: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1739
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1740 :let lpc_use_lpc4_syntax = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1741
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1742 For uLPC series of LPC:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1743 uLPC has been developed to Pike, so you should use Pike syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1744 instead, and the name of your source file should be *.pike
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1745
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1746
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1747 LUA *lua.vim* *ft-lua-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1748
838
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1749 This syntax file may be used for Lua 4.0, Lua 5.0 or Lua 5.1 (the latter is
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1750 the default). You can select one of these versions using the global variables
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1751 lua_version and lua_subversion. For example, to activate Lua
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1752 4.0 syntax highlighting, use this command: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1753
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1754 :let lua_version = 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1755
838
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1756 If you are using Lua 5.0, use these commands: >
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1757
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1758 :let lua_version = 5
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1759 :let lua_subversion = 0
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1760
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1761 To restore highlighting for Lua 5.1: >
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1762
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1763 :let lua_version = 5
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1764 :let lua_subversion = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1765
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1766
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1767 MAIL *mail.vim* *ft-mail.vim*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1768
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1769 Vim highlights all the standard elements of an email (headers, signatures,
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1770 quoted text and URLs / email addresses). In keeping with standard conventions,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1771 signatures begin in a line containing only "--" followed optionally by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1772 whitespaces and end with a newline.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1773
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1774 Vim treats lines beginning with ']', '}', '|', '>' or a word followed by '>'
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1775 as quoted text. However Vim highlights headers and signatures in quoted text
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1776 only if the text is quoted with '>' (optionally followed by one space).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1777
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1778 By default mail.vim synchronises syntax to 100 lines before the first
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1779 displayed line. If you have a slow machine, and generally deal with emails
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1780 with short headers, you can change this to a smaller value: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1781
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1782 :let mail_minlines = 30
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1783
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1784
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1785 MAKE *make.vim* *ft-make-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1786
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1787 In makefiles, commands are usually highlighted to make it easy for you to spot
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1788 errors. However, this may be too much coloring for you. You can turn this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1789 feature off by using: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1790
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1791 :let make_no_commands = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1792
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1793
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1794 MAPLE *maple.vim* *ft-maple-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1795
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1796 Maple V, by Waterloo Maple Inc, supports symbolic algebra. The language
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1797 supports many packages of functions which are selectively loaded by the user.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1798 The standard set of packages' functions as supplied in Maple V release 4 may be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1799 highlighted at the user's discretion. Users may place in their .vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1800
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1801 :let mvpkg_all= 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1802
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1803 to get all package functions highlighted, or users may select any subset by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1804 choosing a variable/package from the table below and setting that variable to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1805 1, also in their .vimrc file (prior to sourcing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1806 $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1807
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1808 Table of Maple V Package Function Selectors >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1809 mv_DEtools mv_genfunc mv_networks mv_process
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1810 mv_Galois mv_geometry mv_numapprox mv_simplex
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1811 mv_GaussInt mv_grobner mv_numtheory mv_stats
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1812 mv_LREtools mv_group mv_orthopoly mv_student
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1813 mv_combinat mv_inttrans mv_padic mv_sumtools
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1814 mv_combstruct mv_liesymm mv_plots mv_tensor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1815 mv_difforms mv_linalg mv_plottools mv_totorder
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1816 mv_finance mv_logic mv_powseries
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1817
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1818
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1819 MATHEMATICA *mma.vim* *ft-mma-syntax* *ft-mathematica-syntax*
271
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1820
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1821 Empty *.m files will automatically be presumed to be Matlab files unless you
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1822 have the following in your .vimrc: >
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1823
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1824 let filetype_m = "mma"
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1825
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1826
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1827 MOO *moo.vim* *ft-moo-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1828
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1829 If you use C-style comments inside expressions and find it mangles your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1830 highlighting, you may want to use extended (slow!) matches for C-style
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1831 comments: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1832
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1833 :let moo_extended_cstyle_comments = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1834
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1835 To disable highlighting of pronoun substitution patterns inside strings: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1836
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1837 :let moo_no_pronoun_sub = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1838
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1839 To disable highlighting of the regular expression operator '%|', and matching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1840 '%(' and '%)' inside strings: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1841
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1842 :let moo_no_regexp = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1843
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1844 Unmatched double quotes can be recognized and highlighted as errors: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1845
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1846 :let moo_unmatched_quotes = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1847
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1848 To highlight builtin properties (.name, .location, .programmer etc.): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1849
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1850 :let moo_builtin_properties = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1851
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1852 Unknown builtin functions can be recognized and highlighted as errors. If you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1853 use this option, add your own extensions to the mooKnownBuiltinFunction group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1854 To enable this option: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1855
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1856 :let moo_unknown_builtin_functions = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1857
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1858 An example of adding sprintf() to the list of known builtin functions: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1859
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1860 :syn keyword mooKnownBuiltinFunction sprintf contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1861
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1862
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1863 MSQL *msql.vim* *ft-msql-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1864
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1865 There are two options for the msql syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1866
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1867 If you like SQL syntax highlighting inside Strings, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1868
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1869 :let msql_sql_query = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1870
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1871 For syncing, minlines defaults to 100. If you prefer another value, you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1872 set "msql_minlines" to the value you desire. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1873
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1874 :let msql_minlines = 200
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1875
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1876
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1877 NCF *ncf.vim* *ft-ncf-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1878
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1879 There is one option for NCF syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1880
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1881 If you want to have unrecognized (by ncf.vim) statements highlighted as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1882 errors, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1883
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1884 :let ncf_highlight_unknowns = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1885
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1886 If you don't want to highlight these errors, leave it unset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1887
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1888
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1889 NROFF *nroff.vim* *ft-nroff-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1890
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1891 The nroff syntax file works with AT&T n/troff out of the box. You need to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1892 activate the GNU groff extra features included in the syntax file before you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1893 can use them.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1894
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1895 For example, Linux and BSD distributions use groff as their default text
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1896 processing package. In order to activate the extra syntax highlighting
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1897 features for groff, add the following option to your start-up files: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1898
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1899 :let b:nroff_is_groff = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1900
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1901 Groff is different from the old AT&T n/troff that you may still find in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1902 Solaris. Groff macro and request names can be longer than 2 characters and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1903 there are extensions to the language primitives. For example, in AT&T troff
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1904 you access the year as a 2-digit number with the request \(yr. In groff you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1905 can use the same request, recognized for compatibility, or you can use groff's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1906 native syntax, \[yr]. Furthermore, you can use a 4-digit year directly:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1907 \[year]. Macro requests can be longer than 2 characters, for example, GNU mm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1908 accepts the requests ".VERBON" and ".VERBOFF" for creating verbatim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1909 environments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1910
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1911 In order to obtain the best formatted output g/troff can give you, you should
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1912 follow a few simple rules about spacing and punctuation.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1913
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1914 1. Do not leave empty spaces at the end of lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1915
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1916 2. Leave one space and one space only after an end-of-sentence period,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1917 exclamation mark, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1918
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1919 3. For reasons stated below, it is best to follow all period marks with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1920 carriage return.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1921
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1922 The reason behind these unusual tips is that g/n/troff have a line breaking
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1923 algorithm that can be easily upset if you don't follow the rules given above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1924
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1925 Unlike TeX, troff fills text line-by-line, not paragraph-by-paragraph and,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1926 furthermore, it does not have a concept of glue or stretch, all horizontal and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1927 vertical space input will be output as is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1928
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1929 Therefore, you should be careful about not using more space between sentences
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1930 than you intend to have in your final document. For this reason, the common
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1931 practice is to insert a carriage return immediately after all punctuation
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1932 marks. If you want to have "even" text in your final processed output, you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1933 need to maintaining regular spacing in the input text. To mark both trailing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1934 spaces and two or more spaces after a punctuation as an error, use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1935
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1936 :let nroff_space_errors = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1937
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1938 Another technique to detect extra spacing and other errors that will interfere
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1939 with the correct typesetting of your file, is to define an eye-catching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1940 highlighting definition for the syntax groups "nroffDefinition" and
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1941 "nroffDefSpecial" in your configuration files. For example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1942
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1943 hi def nroffDefinition term=italic cterm=italic gui=reverse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1944 hi def nroffDefSpecial term=italic,bold cterm=italic,bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1945 \ gui=reverse,bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1946
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1947 If you want to navigate preprocessor entries in your source file as easily as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1948 with section markers, you can activate the following option in your .vimrc
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1949 file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1950
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1951 let b:preprocs_as_sections = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1952
9
4102fb4ea781 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
1953 As well, the syntax file adds an extra paragraph marker for the extended
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1954 paragraph macro (.XP) in the ms package.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1955
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1956 Finally, there is a |groff.vim| syntax file that can be used for enabling
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1957 groff syntax highlighting either on a file basis or globally by default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1958
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1959
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1960 OCAML *ocaml.vim* *ft-ocaml-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1961
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1962 The OCaml syntax file handles files having the following prefixes: .ml,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1963 .mli, .mll and .mly. By setting the following variable >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1964
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1965 :let ocaml_revised = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1966
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1967 you can switch from standard OCaml-syntax to revised syntax as supported
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1968 by the camlp4 preprocessor. Setting the variable >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1969
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1970 :let ocaml_noend_error = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1971
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1972 prevents highlighting of "end" as error, which is useful when sources
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1973 contain very long structures that Vim does not synchronize anymore.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1974
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1975
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1976 PAPP *papp.vim* *ft-papp-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1977
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1978 The PApp syntax file handles .papp files and, to a lesser extend, .pxml
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1979 and .pxsl files which are all a mixture of perl/xml/html/other using xml
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1980 as the top-level file format. By default everything inside phtml or pxml
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1981 sections is treated as a string with embedded preprocessor commands. If
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1982 you set the variable: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1983
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1984 :let papp_include_html=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1985
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1986 in your startup file it will try to syntax-hilight html code inside phtml
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1987 sections, but this is relatively slow and much too colourful to be able to
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1988 edit sensibly. ;)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1989
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1990 The newest version of the papp.vim syntax file can usually be found at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1991 http://papp.plan9.de.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1992
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1993
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1994 PASCAL *pascal.vim* *ft-pascal-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1995
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1996 Files matching "*.p" could be Progress or Pascal. If the automatic detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1997 doesn't work for you, or you don't edit Progress at all, use this in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1998 startup vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1999
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2000 :let filetype_p = "pascal"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2001
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2002 The Pascal syntax file has been extended to take into account some extensions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2003 provided by Turbo Pascal, Free Pascal Compiler and GNU Pascal Compiler.
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2004 Delphi keywords are also supported. By default, Turbo Pascal 7.0 features are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2005 enabled. If you prefer to stick with the standard Pascal keywords, add the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2006 following line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2007
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2008 :let pascal_traditional=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2009
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2010 To switch on Delphi specific constructions (such as one-line comments,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2011 keywords, etc): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2012
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2013 :let pascal_delphi=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2014
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2015
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2016 The option pascal_symbol_operator controls whether symbol operators such as +,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2017 *, .., etc. are displayed using the Operator color or not. To colorize symbol
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2018 operators, add the following line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2019
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2020 :let pascal_symbol_operator=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2021
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2022 Some functions are highlighted by default. To switch it off: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2023
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2024 :let pascal_no_functions=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2025
2283
7e1bd501306d Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2269
diff changeset
2026 Furthermore, there are specific variables for some compilers. Besides
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2027 pascal_delphi, there are pascal_gpc and pascal_fpc. Default extensions try to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2028 match Turbo Pascal. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2029
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2030 :let pascal_gpc=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2031
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2032 or >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2033
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2034 :let pascal_fpc=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2035
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2036 To ensure that strings are defined on a single line, you can define the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2037 pascal_one_line_string variable. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2038
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2039 :let pascal_one_line_string=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2040
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2041 If you dislike <Tab> chars, you can set the pascal_no_tabs variable. Tabs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2042 will be highlighted as Error. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2043
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2044 :let pascal_no_tabs=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2045
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2046
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2047
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2048 PERL *perl.vim* *ft-perl-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2049
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2050 There are a number of possible options to the perl syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2051
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2052 If you use POD files or POD segments, you might: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2053
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2054 :let perl_include_pod = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2055
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2056 The reduce the complexity of parsing (and increase performance) you can switch
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2057 off two elements in the parsing of variable names and contents. >
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2058
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2059 To handle package references in variable and function names not differently
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2060 from the rest of the name (like 'PkgName::' in '$PkgName::VarName'): >
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2061
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2062 :let perl_no_scope_in_variables = 1
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2063
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2064 (In Vim 6.x it was the other way around: "perl_want_scope_in_variables"
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2065 enabled it.)
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2066
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2067 If you do not want complex things like '@{${"foo"}}' to be parsed: >
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2068
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2069 :let perl_no_extended_vars = 1
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2070
26
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 24
diff changeset
2071 (In Vim 6.x it was the other way around: "perl_extended_vars" enabled it.)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2072
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2073 The coloring strings can be changed. By default strings and qq friends will be
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2074 highlighted like the first line. If you set the variable
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2075 perl_string_as_statement, it will be highlighted as in the second line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2076
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2077 "hello world!"; qq|hello world|;
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2078 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^NN^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^N (unlet perl_string_as_statement)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2079 S^^^^^^^^^^^^SNNSSS^^^^^^^^^^^SN (let perl_string_as_statement)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2080
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2081 (^ = perlString, S = perlStatement, N = None at all)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2082
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2083 The syncing has 3 options. The first two switch off some triggering of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2084 synchronization and should only be needed in case it fails to work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2085 If while scrolling all of a sudden the whole screen changes color completely
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2086 then you should try and switch off one of those. Let me know if you can figure
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2087 out the line that causes the mistake.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2088
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2089 One triggers on "^\s*sub\s*" and the other on "^[$@%]" more or less. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2090
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2091 :let perl_no_sync_on_sub
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2092 :let perl_no_sync_on_global_var
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2093
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2094 Below you can set the maximum distance VIM should look for starting points for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2095 its attempts in syntax highlighting. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2096
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2097 :let perl_sync_dist = 100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2098
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2099 If you want to use folding with perl, set perl_fold: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2100
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2101 :let perl_fold = 1
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2102
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2103 If you want to fold blocks in if statements, etc. as well set the following: >
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2104
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2105 :let perl_fold_blocks = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2106
632
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2107 To avoid folding packages or subs when perl_fold is let, let the appropriate
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2108 variable(s): >
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2109
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
2110 :unlet perl_nofold_packages
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
2111 :unlet perl_nofold_subs
632
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2112
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2113
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2114
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2115 PHP3 and PHP4 *php.vim* *php3.vim* *ft-php-syntax* *ft-php3-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2116
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2117 [note: previously this was called "php3", but since it now also supports php4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2118 it has been renamed to "php"]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2119
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2120 There are the following options for the php syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2121
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2122 If you like SQL syntax highlighting inside Strings: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2123
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2124 let php_sql_query = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2125
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2126 For highlighting the Baselib methods: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2127
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2128 let php_baselib = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2129
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2130 Enable HTML syntax highlighting inside strings: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2131
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2132 let php_htmlInStrings = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2133
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2134 Using the old colorstyle: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2135
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2136 let php_oldStyle = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2137
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2138 Enable highlighting ASP-style short tags: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2139
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2140 let php_asp_tags = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2141
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2142 Disable short tags: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2143
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2144 let php_noShortTags = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2145
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2146 For highlighting parent error ] or ): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2147
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2148 let php_parent_error_close = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2149
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2150 For skipping an php end tag, if there exists an open ( or [ without a closing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2151 one: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2152
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2153 let php_parent_error_open = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2154
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2155 Enable folding for classes and functions: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2156
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2157 let php_folding = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2158
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2159 Selecting syncing method: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2160
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2161 let php_sync_method = x
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2162
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2163 x = -1 to sync by search (default),
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2164 x > 0 to sync at least x lines backwards,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2165 x = 0 to sync from start.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2166
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2167
816
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2168 PLAINTEX *plaintex.vim* *ft-plaintex-syntax*
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2169
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2170 TeX is a typesetting language, and plaintex is the file type for the "plain"
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2171 variant of TeX. If you never want your *.tex files recognized as plain TeX,
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
2172 see |ft-tex-plugin|.
816
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2173
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2174 This syntax file has the option >
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2175
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2176 let g:plaintex_delimiters = 1
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2177
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2178 if you want to highlight brackets "[]" and braces "{}".
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2179
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2180
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2181 PPWIZARD *ppwiz.vim* *ft-ppwiz-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2182
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2183 PPWizard is a preprocessor for HTML and OS/2 INF files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2184
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2185 This syntax file has the options:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2186
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2187 - ppwiz_highlight_defs : determines highlighting mode for PPWizard's
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2188 definitions. Possible values are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2189
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2190 ppwiz_highlight_defs = 1 : PPWizard #define statements retain the
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2191 colors of their contents (e.g. PPWizard macros and variables)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2192
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2193 ppwiz_highlight_defs = 2 : preprocessor #define and #evaluate
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2194 statements are shown in a single color with the exception of line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2195 continuation symbols
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2196
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2197 The default setting for ppwiz_highlight_defs is 1.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2198
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2199 - ppwiz_with_html : If the value is 1 (the default), highlight literal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2200 HTML code; if 0, treat HTML code like ordinary text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2201
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2202
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2203 PHTML *phtml.vim* *ft-phtml-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2204
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2205 There are two options for the phtml syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2206
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2207 If you like SQL syntax highlighting inside Strings, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2208
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2209 :let phtml_sql_query = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2210
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2211 For syncing, minlines defaults to 100. If you prefer another value, you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2212 set "phtml_minlines" to the value you desire. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2213
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2214 :let phtml_minlines = 200
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2215
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2216
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2217 POSTSCRIPT *postscr.vim* *ft-postscr-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2218
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2219 There are several options when it comes to highlighting PostScript.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2220
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2221 First which version of the PostScript language to highlight. There are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2222 currently three defined language versions, or levels. Level 1 is the original
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2223 and base version, and includes all extensions prior to the release of level 2.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2224 Level 2 is the most common version around, and includes its own set of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2225 extensions prior to the release of level 3. Level 3 is currently the highest
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2226 level supported. You select which level of the PostScript language you want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2227 highlighted by defining the postscr_level variable as follows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2228
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2229 :let postscr_level=2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2230
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2231 If this variable is not defined it defaults to 2 (level 2) since this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2232 the most prevalent version currently.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2233
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2234 Note, not all PS interpreters will support all language features for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2235 particular language level. In particular the %!PS-Adobe-3.0 at the start of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2236 PS files does NOT mean the PostScript present is level 3 PostScript!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2237
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2238 If you are working with Display PostScript, you can include highlighting of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2239 Display PS language features by defining the postscr_display variable as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2240 follows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2241
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2242 :let postscr_display=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2243
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2244 If you are working with Ghostscript, you can include highlighting of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2245 Ghostscript specific language features by defining the variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2246 postscr_ghostscript as follows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2247
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2248 :let postscr_ghostscript=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2249
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2250 PostScript is a large language, with many predefined elements. While it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2251 useful to have all these elements highlighted, on slower machines this can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2252 cause Vim to slow down. In an attempt to be machine friendly font names and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2253 character encodings are not highlighted by default. Unless you are working
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2254 explicitly with either of these this should be ok. If you want them to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2255 highlighted you should set one or both of the following variables: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2256
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2257 :let postscr_fonts=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2258 :let postscr_encodings=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2259
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2260 There is a stylistic option to the highlighting of and, or, and not. In
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2261 PostScript the function of these operators depends on the types of their
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2262 operands - if the operands are booleans then they are the logical operators,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2263 if they are integers then they are binary operators. As binary and logical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2264 operators can be highlighted differently they have to be highlighted one way
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2265 or the other. By default they are treated as logical operators. They can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2266 highlighted as binary operators by defining the variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2267 postscr_andornot_binary as follows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2268
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2269 :let postscr_andornot_binary=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2270 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2271
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2272 *ptcap.vim* *ft-printcap-syntax*
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2273 PRINTCAP + TERMCAP *ft-ptcap-syntax* *ft-termcap-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2274
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2275 This syntax file applies to the printcap and termcap databases.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2276
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2277 In order for Vim to recognize printcap/termcap files that do not match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2278 the patterns *printcap*, or *termcap*, you must put additional patterns
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2279 appropriate to your system in your |myfiletypefile| file. For these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2280 patterns, you must set the variable "b:ptcap_type" to either "print" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2281 "term", and then the 'filetype' option to ptcap.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2282
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2283 For example, to make Vim identify all files in /etc/termcaps/ as termcap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2284 files, add the following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2285
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2286 :au BufNewFile,BufRead /etc/termcaps/* let b:ptcap_type = "term" |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2287 \ set filetype=ptcap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2288
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2289 If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards, which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2290 are fixed when redrawing with CTRL-L, try setting the "ptcap_minlines"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2291 internal variable to a larger number: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2292
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2293 :let ptcap_minlines = 50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2294
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2295 (The default is 20 lines.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2296
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2297
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2298 PROGRESS *progress.vim* *ft-progress-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2299
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2300 Files matching "*.w" could be Progress or cweb. If the automatic detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2301 doesn't work for you, or you don't edit cweb at all, use this in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2302 startup vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2303 :let filetype_w = "progress"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2304 The same happens for "*.i", which could be assembly, and "*.p", which could be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2305 Pascal. Use this if you don't use assembly and Pascal: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2306 :let filetype_i = "progress"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2307 :let filetype_p = "progress"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2308
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2309
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2310 PYTHON *python.vim* *ft-python-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2311
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2312 There are four options to control Python syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2313
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2314 For highlighted numbers: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2315 :let python_highlight_numbers = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2316
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2317 For highlighted builtin functions: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2318 :let python_highlight_builtins = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2319
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2320 For highlighted standard exceptions: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2321 :let python_highlight_exceptions = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2322
2596
fae782ef63dd Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2581
diff changeset
2323 For highlighted trailing whitespace and mix of spaces and tabs: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2324 :let python_highlight_space_errors = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2325
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2326 If you want all possible Python highlighting (the same as setting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2327 preceding three options): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2328 :let python_highlight_all = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2329
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2330
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2331 QUAKE *quake.vim* *ft-quake-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2332
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2333 The Quake syntax definition should work for most any FPS (First Person
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2334 Shooter) based on one of the Quake engines. However, the command names vary
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2335 a bit between the three games (Quake, Quake 2, and Quake 3 Arena) so the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2336 syntax definition checks for the existence of three global variables to allow
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2337 users to specify what commands are legal in their files. The three variables
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2338 can be set for the following effects:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2339
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2340 set to highlight commands only available in Quake: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2341 :let quake_is_quake1 = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2342
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2343 set to highlight commands only available in Quake 2: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2344 :let quake_is_quake2 = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2345
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2346 set to highlight commands only available in Quake 3 Arena: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2347 :let quake_is_quake3 = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2348
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2349 Any combination of these three variables is legal, but might highlight more
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2350 commands than are actually available to you by the game.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2351
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2352
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2353 READLINE *readline.vim* *ft-readline-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2354
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2355 The readline library is primarily used by the BASH shell, which adds quite a
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2356 few commands and options to the ones already available. To highlight these
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2357 items as well you can add the following to your |vimrc| or just type it in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2358 command line before loading a file with the readline syntax: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2359 let readline_has_bash = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2360
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2361 This will add highlighting for the commands that BASH (version 2.05a and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2362 later, and part earlier) adds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2363
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2364
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2365 REXX *rexx.vim* *ft-rexx-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2366
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2367 If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards, which are fixed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2368 when redrawing with CTRL-L, try setting the "rexx_minlines" internal variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2369 to a larger number: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2370 :let rexx_minlines = 50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2371 This will make the syntax synchronization start 50 lines before the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2372 displayed line. The default value is 10. The disadvantage of using a larger
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2373 number is that redrawing can become slow.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2374
2965
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
2375 Vim tries to guess what type a ".r" file is. If it can't be detected (from
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
2376 comment lines), the default is "r". To make the default rexx add this line to
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
2377 your .vimrc: *g:filetype_r*
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
2378 >
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
2379 :let g:filetype_r = "r"
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
2380
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2381
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2382 RUBY *ruby.vim* *ft-ruby-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2383
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2384 There are a number of options to the Ruby syntax highlighting.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2385
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2386 By default, the "end" keyword is colorized according to the opening statement
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2387 of the block it closes. While useful, this feature can be expensive; if you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2388 experience slow redrawing (or you are on a terminal with poor color support)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2389 you may want to turn it off by defining the "ruby_no_expensive" variable: >
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2390
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2391 :let ruby_no_expensive = 1
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2392 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2393 In this case the same color will be used for all control keywords.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2394
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2395 If you do want this feature enabled, but notice highlighting errors while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2396 scrolling backwards, which are fixed when redrawing with CTRL-L, try setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2397 the "ruby_minlines" variable to a value larger than 50: >
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2398
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2399 :let ruby_minlines = 100
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2400 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2401 Ideally, this value should be a number of lines large enough to embrace your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2402 largest class or module.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2403
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2404 Highlighting of special identifiers can be disabled by removing the
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2405 rubyIdentifier highlighting: >
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2406
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2407 :hi link rubyIdentifier NONE
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2408 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2409 This will prevent highlighting of special identifiers like "ConstantName",
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2410 "$global_var", "@@class_var", "@instance_var", "| block_param |", and
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2411 ":symbol".
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2412
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2413 Significant methods of Kernel, Module and Object are highlighted by default.
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2414 This can be disabled by defining "ruby_no_special_methods": >
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2415
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2416 :let ruby_no_special_methods = 1
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2417 <
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2418 This will prevent highlighting of important methods such as "require", "attr",
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2419 "private", "raise" and "proc".
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2420
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2421 Ruby operators can be highlighted. This is enabled by defining
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2422 "ruby_operators": >
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2423
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2424 :let ruby_operators = 1
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2425 <
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2426 Whitespace errors can be highlighted by defining "ruby_space_errors": >
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2427
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2428 :let ruby_space_errors = 1
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2429 <
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2430 This will highlight trailing whitespace and tabs preceded by a space character
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2431 as errors. This can be refined by defining "ruby_no_trail_space_error" and
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2432 "ruby_no_tab_space_error" which will ignore trailing whitespace and tabs after
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2433 spaces respectively.
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2434
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2435 Folding can be enabled by defining "ruby_fold": >
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2436
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2437 :let ruby_fold = 1
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2438 <
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2439 This will set the 'foldmethod' option to "syntax" and allow folding of
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2440 classes, modules, methods, code blocks, heredocs and comments.
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2441
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2442 Folding of multiline comments can be disabled by defining
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2443 "ruby_no_comment_fold": >
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2444
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2445 :let ruby_no_comment_fold = 1
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2446 <
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2447
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2448 SCHEME *scheme.vim* *ft-scheme-syntax*
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2449
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2450 By default only R5RS keywords are highlighted and properly indented.
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2451
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2452 MzScheme-specific stuff will be used if b:is_mzscheme or g:is_mzscheme
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2453 variables are defined.
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
2454
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 32
diff changeset
2455 Also scheme.vim supports keywords of the Chicken Scheme->C compiler. Define
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 32
diff changeset
2456 b:is_chicken or g:is_chicken, if you need them.
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2457
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2458
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2459 SDL *sdl.vim* *ft-sdl-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2460
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2461 The SDL highlighting probably misses a few keywords, but SDL has so many
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2462 of them it's almost impossibly to cope.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2463
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2464 The new standard, SDL-2000, specifies that all identifiers are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2465 case-sensitive (which was not so before), and that all keywords can be
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2466 used either completely lowercase or completely uppercase. To have the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2467 highlighting reflect this, you can set the following variable: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2468 :let sdl_2000=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2469
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2470 This also sets many new keywords. If you want to disable the old
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2471 keywords, which is probably a good idea, use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2472 :let SDL_no_96=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2473
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2474
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2475 The indentation is probably also incomplete, but right now I am very
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2476 satisfied with it for my own projects.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2477
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2478
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2479 SED *sed.vim* *ft-sed-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2480
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2481 To make tabs stand out from regular blanks (accomplished by using Todo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2482 highlighting on the tabs), define "highlight_sedtabs" by putting >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2483
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2484 :let highlight_sedtabs = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2485
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2486 in the vimrc file. (This special highlighting only applies for tabs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2487 inside search patterns, replacement texts, addresses or text included
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2488 by an Append/Change/Insert command.) If you enable this option, it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2489 also a good idea to set the tab width to one character; by doing that,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2490 you can easily count the number of tabs in a string.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2491
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2492 Bugs:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2493
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2494 The transform command (y) is treated exactly like the substitute
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2495 command. This means that, as far as this syntax file is concerned,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2496 transform accepts the same flags as substitute, which is wrong.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2497 (Transform accepts no flags.) I tolerate this bug because the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2498 involved commands need very complex treatment (95 patterns, one for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2499 each plausible pattern delimiter).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2500
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2501
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2502 SGML *sgml.vim* *ft-sgml-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2503
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2504 The coloring scheme for tags in the SGML file works as follows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2505
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2506 The <> of opening tags are colored differently than the </> of a closing tag.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2507 This is on purpose! For opening tags the 'Function' color is used, while for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2508 closing tags the 'Type' color is used (See syntax.vim to check how those are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2509 defined for you)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2510
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2511 Known tag names are colored the same way as statements in C. Unknown tag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2512 names are not colored which makes it easy to spot errors.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2513
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2514 Note that the same is true for argument (or attribute) names. Known attribute
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2515 names are colored differently than unknown ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2516
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2517 Some SGML tags are used to change the rendering of text. The following tags
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2518 are recognized by the sgml.vim syntax coloring file and change the way normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2519 text is shown: <varname> <emphasis> <command> <function> <literal>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2520 <replaceable> <ulink> and <link>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2521
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2522 If you want to change how such text is rendered, you must redefine the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2523 following syntax groups:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2524
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2525 - sgmlBold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2526 - sgmlBoldItalic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2527 - sgmlUnderline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2528 - sgmlItalic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2529 - sgmlLink for links
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2530
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2531 To make this redefinition work you must redefine them all and define the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2532 following variable in your vimrc (this is due to the order in which the files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2533 are read during initialization) >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2534 let sgml_my_rendering=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2535
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2536 You can also disable this rendering by adding the following line to your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2537 vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2538 let sgml_no_rendering=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2539
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2540 (Adapted from the html.vim help text by Claudio Fleiner <claudio@fleiner.com>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2541
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2542
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2543 SH *sh.vim* *ft-sh-syntax* *ft-bash-syntax* *ft-ksh-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2544
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2545 This covers the "normal" Unix (Bourne) sh, bash and the Korn shell.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2546
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2547 Vim attempts to determine which shell type is in use by specifying that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2548 various filenames are of specific types: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2549
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2550 ksh : .kshrc* *.ksh
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2551 bash: .bashrc* bashrc bash.bashrc .bash_profile* *.bash
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2552 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2553 If none of these cases pertain, then the first line of the file is examined
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2554 (ex. /bin/sh /bin/ksh /bin/bash). If the first line specifies a shelltype,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2555 then that shelltype is used. However some files (ex. .profile) are known to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2556 be shell files but the type is not apparent. Furthermore, on many systems
828
01583c79d5f4 updated for version 7.0d03
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2557 sh is symbolically linked to "bash" (Linux, Windows+cygwin) or "ksh" (Posix).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2558
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2559 One may specify a global default by instantiating one of the following three
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2560 variables in your <.vimrc>:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2561
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2562 ksh: >
828
01583c79d5f4 updated for version 7.0d03
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2563 let g:is_kornshell = 1
01583c79d5f4 updated for version 7.0d03
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2564 < posix: (using this is the same as setting is_kornshell to 1) >
01583c79d5f4 updated for version 7.0d03
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2565 let g:is_posix = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2566 < bash: >
828
01583c79d5f4 updated for version 7.0d03
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2567 let g:is_bash = 1
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2568 < sh: (default) Bourne shell >
828
01583c79d5f4 updated for version 7.0d03
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2569 let g:is_sh = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2570
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
2571 If there's no "#! ..." line, and the user hasn't availed himself/herself of a
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
2572 default sh.vim syntax setting as just shown, then syntax/sh.vim will assume
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2573 the Bourne shell syntax. No need to quote RFCs or market penetration
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2574 statistics in error reports, please -- just select the default version of the
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2575 sh your system uses in your <.vimrc>.
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2576
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2577 The syntax/sh.vim file provides several levels of syntax-based folding: >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2578
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2579 let g:sh_fold_enabled= 0 (default, no syntax folding)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2580 let g:sh_fold_enabled= 1 (enable function folding)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2581 let g:sh_fold_enabled= 2 (enable heredoc folding)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2582 let g:sh_fold_enabled= 4 (enable if/do/for folding)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2583 >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2584 then various syntax items (HereDocuments and function bodies) become
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2585 syntax-foldable (see |:syn-fold|). You also may add these together
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2586 to get multiple types of folding: >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2587
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2588 let g:sh_fold_enabled= 3 (enables function and heredoc folding)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2589
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2590 If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards which are fixed
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2591 when one redraws with CTRL-L, try setting the "sh_minlines" internal variable
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2592 to a larger number. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2593
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2594 let sh_minlines = 500
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2595
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2596 This will make syntax synchronization start 500 lines before the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2597 displayed line. The default value is 200. The disadvantage of using a larger
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2598 number is that redrawing can become slow.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2599
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2600 If you don't have much to synchronize on, displaying can be very slow. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2601 reduce this, the "sh_maxlines" internal variable can be set. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2602
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2603 let sh_maxlines = 100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2604 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2605 The default is to use the twice sh_minlines. Set it to a smaller number to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2606 speed up displaying. The disadvantage is that highlight errors may appear.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2607
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2608
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2609 SPEEDUP (AspenTech plant simulator) *spup.vim* *ft-spup-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2610
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2611 The Speedup syntax file has some options:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2612
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2613 - strict_subsections : If this variable is defined, only keywords for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2614 sections and subsections will be highlighted as statements but not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2615 other keywords (like WITHIN in the OPERATION section).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2616
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2617 - highlight_types : Definition of this variable causes stream types
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2618 like temperature or pressure to be highlighted as Type, not as a
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2619 plain Identifier. Included are the types that are usually found in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2620 the DECLARE section; if you defined own types, you have to include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2621 them in the syntax file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2622
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2623 - oneline_comments : this value ranges from 1 to 3 and determines the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2624 highlighting of # style comments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2625
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2626 oneline_comments = 1 : allow normal Speedup code after an even
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2627 number of #s.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2628
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2629 oneline_comments = 2 : show code starting with the second # as
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2630 error. This is the default setting.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2631
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2632 oneline_comments = 3 : show the whole line as error if it contains
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2633 more than one #.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2634
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2635 Since especially OPERATION sections tend to become very large due to
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2636 PRESETting variables, syncing may be critical. If your computer is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2637 fast enough, you can increase minlines and/or maxlines near the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2638 the syntax file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2639
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2640
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2641 SQL *sql.vim* *ft-sql-syntax*
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2642 *sqlinformix.vim* *ft-sqlinformix-syntax*
720
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2643 *sqlanywhere.vim* *ft-sqlanywhere-syntax*
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2644
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2645 While there is an ANSI standard for SQL, most database engines add their own
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2646 custom extensions. Vim currently supports the Oracle and Informix dialects of
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2647 SQL. Vim assumes "*.sql" files are Oracle SQL by default.
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2648
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2649 Vim currently has SQL support for a variety of different vendors via syntax
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2650 scripts. You can change Vim's default from Oracle to any of the current SQL
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2651 supported types. You can also easily alter the SQL dialect being used on a
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2652 buffer by buffer basis.
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2653
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2654 For more detailed instructions see |ft_sql.txt|.
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2655
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2656
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2657 TCSH *tcsh.vim* *ft-tcsh-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2658
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2659 This covers the shell named "tcsh". It is a superset of csh. See |csh.vim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2660 for how the filetype is detected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2661
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2662 Tcsh does not allow \" in strings unless the "backslash_quote" shell variable
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2663 is set. If you want VIM to assume that no backslash quote constructs exist add
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2664 this line to your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2665
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2666 :let tcsh_backslash_quote = 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2667
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2668 If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards, which are fixed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2669 when redrawing with CTRL-L, try setting the "tcsh_minlines" internal variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2670 to a larger number: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2671
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2672 :let tcsh_minlines = 1000
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2673
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2674 This will make the syntax synchronization start 1000 lines before the first
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2675 displayed line. If you set "tcsh_minlines" to "fromstart", then
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2676 synchronization is done from the start of the file. The default value for
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2677 tcsh_minlines is 100. The disadvantage of using a larger number is that
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2678 redrawing can become slow.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2679
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2680
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2681 TEX *tex.vim* *ft-tex-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2682
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2683 *tex-folding*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2684 Tex: Want Syntax Folding? ~
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2685
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2686 As of version 28 of <syntax/tex.vim>, syntax-based folding of parts, chapters,
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2687 sections, subsections, etc are supported. Put >
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2688 let g:tex_fold_enabled=1
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2689 in your <.vimrc>, and :set fdm=syntax. I suggest doing the latter via a
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2690 modeline at the end of your LaTeX file: >
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2691 % vim: fdm=syntax
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2692 <
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2693 *tex-nospell*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2694 Tex: Don't Want Spell Checking In Comments? ~
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2695
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2696 Some folks like to include things like source code in comments and so would
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2697 prefer that spell checking be disabled in comments in LaTeX files. To do
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2698 this, put the following in your <.vimrc>: >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2699 let g:tex_comment_nospell= 1
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2700 <
2494
ed997d0ceb26 Updated syntax files. (Charles Campbell)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
2701 *tex-verb*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2702 Tex: Want Spell Checking in Verbatim Zones?~
2494
ed997d0ceb26 Updated syntax files. (Charles Campbell)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
2703
ed997d0ceb26 Updated syntax files. (Charles Campbell)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
2704 Often verbatim regions are used for things like source code; seldom does
ed997d0ceb26 Updated syntax files. (Charles Campbell)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
2705 one want source code spell-checked. However, for those of you who do
ed997d0ceb26 Updated syntax files. (Charles Campbell)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
2706 want your verbatim zones spell-checked, put the following in your <.vimrc>: >
ed997d0ceb26 Updated syntax files. (Charles Campbell)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
2707 let g:tex_verbspell= 1
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2708 <
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2709 *tex-runon*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2710 Tex: Run-on Comments or MathZones ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2711
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2712 The <syntax/tex.vim> highlighting supports TeX, LaTeX, and some AmsTeX. The
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2713 highlighting supports three primary zones/regions: normal, texZone, and
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2714 texMathZone. Although considerable effort has been made to have these zones
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2715 terminate properly, zones delineated by $..$ and $$..$$ cannot be synchronized
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2716 as there's no difference between start and end patterns. Consequently, a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2717 special "TeX comment" has been provided >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2718 %stopzone
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2719 which will forcibly terminate the highlighting of either a texZone or a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2720 texMathZone.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2721
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2722 *tex-slow*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2723 Tex: Slow Syntax Highlighting? ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2724
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2725 If you have a slow computer, you may wish to reduce the values for >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2726 :syn sync maxlines=200
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2727 :syn sync minlines=50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2728 (especially the latter). If your computer is fast, you may wish to
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2729 increase them. This primarily affects synchronizing (i.e. just what group,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2730 if any, is the text at the top of the screen supposed to be in?).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2731
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2732 *tex-morecommands* *tex-package*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2733 Tex: Want To Highlight More Commands? ~
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2734
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2735 LaTeX is a programmable language, and so there are thousands of packages full
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2736 of specialized LaTeX commands, syntax, and fonts. If you're using such a
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2737 package you'll often wish that the distributed syntax/tex.vim would support
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2738 it. However, clearly this is impractical. So please consider using the
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2739 techniques in |mysyntaxfile-add| to extend or modify the highlighting provided
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2740 by syntax/tex.vim.
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2741
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2742 *tex-error*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2743 Tex: Excessive Error Highlighting? ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2744
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2745 The <tex.vim> supports lexical error checking of various sorts. Thus,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2746 although the error checking is ofttimes very useful, it can indicate
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2747 errors where none actually are. If this proves to be a problem for you,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2748 you may put in your <.vimrc> the following statement: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2749 let tex_no_error=1
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2750 and all error checking by <syntax/tex.vim> will be suppressed.
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2751
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2752 *tex-math*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2753 Tex: Need a new Math Group? ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2754
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2755 If you want to include a new math group in your LaTeX, the following
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2756 code shows you an example as to how you might do so: >
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2757 call TexNewMathZone(sfx,mathzone,starform)
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2758 You'll want to provide the new math group with a unique suffix
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2759 (currently, A-L and V-Z are taken by <syntax/tex.vim> itself).
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2760 As an example, consider how eqnarray is set up by <syntax/tex.vim>: >
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2761 call TexNewMathZone("D","eqnarray",1)
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2762 You'll need to change "mathzone" to the name of your new math group,
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2763 and then to the call to it in .vim/after/syntax/tex.vim.
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2764 The "starform" variable, if true, implies that your new math group
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2765 has a starred form (ie. eqnarray*).
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2766
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2767 *tex-style*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2768 Tex: Starting a New Style? ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2769
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2770 One may use "\makeatletter" in *.tex files, thereby making the use of "@" in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2771 commands available. However, since the *.tex file doesn't have one of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2772 following suffices: sty cls clo dtx ltx, the syntax highlighting will flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2773 such use of @ as an error. To solve this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2774
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2775 :let b:tex_stylish = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2776 :set ft=tex
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2777
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2778 Putting "let g:tex_stylish=1" into your <.vimrc> will make <syntax/tex.vim>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2779 always accept such use of @.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2780
2417
acfb7eddf13c Update TeX syntax file.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
2781 *tex-cchar* *tex-cole* *tex-conceal*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2782 Tex: Taking Advantage of Conceal Mode~
2417
acfb7eddf13c Update TeX syntax file.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
2783
2426
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2784 If you have |'conceallevel'| set to 2 and if your encoding is utf-8, then a
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2785 number of character sequences can be translated into appropriate utf-8 glyphs,
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2786 including various accented characters, Greek characters in MathZones, and
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2787 superscripts and subscripts in MathZones. Not all characters can be made into
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2788 superscripts or subscripts; the constraint is due to what utf-8 supports.
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2789 In fact, only a few characters are supported as subscripts.
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2790
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2791 One way to use this is to have vertically split windows (see |CTRL-W_v|); one
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2792 with |'conceallevel'| at 0 and the other at 2; and both using |'scrollbind'|.
2417
acfb7eddf13c Update TeX syntax file.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
2793
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2794 *g:tex_conceal*
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2795 Tex: Selective Conceal Mode~
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2796
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2797 You may selectively use conceal mode by setting g:tex_conceal in your
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2798 <.vimrc>. By default it is set to "admgs" to enable conceal for the
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2799 following sets of characters: >
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2800
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2801 a = accents/ligatures
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2802 d = delimiters
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2803 m = math symbols
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2804 g = Greek
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2805 s = superscripts/subscripts
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2806 <
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2807 By leaving one or more of these out, the associated conceal-character
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2808 substitution will not be made.
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2809
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2810
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2811 TF *tf.vim* *ft-tf-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2812
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2813 There is one option for the tf syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2814
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2815 For syncing, minlines defaults to 100. If you prefer another value, you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2816 set "tf_minlines" to the value you desire. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2817
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2818 :let tf_minlines = your choice
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2819
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2820
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2821 VIM *vim.vim* *ft-vim-syntax*
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2822 *g:vimsyn_minlines* *g:vimsyn_maxlines*
2283
7e1bd501306d Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2269
diff changeset
2823 There is a trade-off between more accurate syntax highlighting versus screen
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2824 updating speed. To improve accuracy, you may wish to increase the
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2825 g:vimsyn_minlines variable. The g:vimsyn_maxlines variable may be used to
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2826 improve screen updating rates (see |:syn-sync| for more on this). >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2827
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2828 g:vimsyn_minlines : used to set synchronization minlines
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2829 g:vimsyn_maxlines : used to set synchronization maxlines
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2830 <
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2831 (g:vim_minlines and g:vim_maxlines are deprecated variants of
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2832 these two options)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2833
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2834 *g:vimsyn_embed*
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2835 The g:vimsyn_embed option allows users to select what, if any, types of
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2836 embedded script highlighting they wish to have. >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2837
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2838 g:vimsyn_embed == 0 : don't embed any scripts
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2839 g:vimsyn_embed =~ 'm' : embed mzscheme (but only if vim supports it)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2840 g:vimsyn_embed =~ 'p' : embed perl (but only if vim supports it)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2841 g:vimsyn_embed =~ 'P' : embed python (but only if vim supports it)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2842 g:vimsyn_embed =~ 'r' : embed ruby (but only if vim supports it)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2843 g:vimsyn_embed =~ 't' : embed tcl (but only if vim supports it)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2844 <
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2845 By default, g:vimsyn_embed is "mpPr"; ie. syntax/vim.vim will support
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2846 highlighting mzscheme, perl, python, and ruby by default. Vim's has("tcl")
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2847 test appears to hang vim when tcl is not truly available. Thus, by default,
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2848 tcl is not supported for embedding (but those of you who like tcl embedded in
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2849 their vim syntax highlighting can simply include it in the g:vimembedscript
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2850 option).
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2851 *g:vimsyn_folding*
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2852
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2853 Some folding is now supported with syntax/vim.vim: >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2854
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2855 g:vimsyn_folding == 0 or doesn't exist: no syntax-based folding
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2856 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'a' : augroups
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2857 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'f' : fold functions
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2858 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'm' : fold mzscheme script
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2859 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'p' : fold perl script
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2860 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'P' : fold python script
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2861 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'r' : fold ruby script
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2862 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 't' : fold tcl script
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2863
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2864 *g:vimsyn_noerror*
846
db44f7b81373 updated for version 7.0f03
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
2865 Not all error highlighting that syntax/vim.vim does may be correct; VimL is a
db44f7b81373 updated for version 7.0f03
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
2866 difficult language to highlight correctly. A way to suppress error
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2867 highlighting is to put the following line in your |vimrc|: >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2868
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2869 let g:vimsyn_noerror = 1
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2870 <
846
db44f7b81373 updated for version 7.0f03
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
2871
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2872
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2873 XF86CONFIG *xf86conf.vim* *ft-xf86conf-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2874
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2875 The syntax of XF86Config file differs in XFree86 v3.x and v4.x. Both
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2876 variants are supported. Automatic detection is used, but is far from perfect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2877 You may need to specify the version manually. Set the variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2878 xf86conf_xfree86_version to 3 or 4 according to your XFree86 version in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2879 your .vimrc. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2880 :let xf86conf_xfree86_version=3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2881 When using a mix of versions, set the b:xf86conf_xfree86_version variable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2882
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2883 Note that spaces and underscores in option names are not supported. Use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2884 "SyncOnGreen" instead of "__s yn con gr_e_e_n" if you want the option name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2885 highlighted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2886
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2887
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2888 XML *xml.vim* *ft-xml-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2889
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2890 Xml namespaces are highlighted by default. This can be inhibited by
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2891 setting a global variable: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2892
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2893 :let g:xml_namespace_transparent=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2894 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2895 *xml-folding*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2896 The xml syntax file provides syntax |folding| (see |:syn-fold|) between
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2897 start and end tags. This can be turned on by >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2898
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2899 :let g:xml_syntax_folding = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2900 :set foldmethod=syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2901
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2902 Note: syntax folding might slow down syntax highlighting significantly,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2903 especially for large files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2904
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2905
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2906 X Pixmaps (XPM) *xpm.vim* *ft-xpm-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2907
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2908 xpm.vim creates its syntax items dynamically based upon the contents of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2909 XPM file. Thus if you make changes e.g. in the color specification strings,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2910 you have to source it again e.g. with ":set syn=xpm".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2911
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2912 To copy a pixel with one of the colors, yank a "pixel" with "yl" and insert it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2913 somewhere else with "P".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2914
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2915 Do you want to draw with the mouse? Try the following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2916 :function! GetPixel()
823
9ab23f1e137f updated for version 7.0c12
vimboss
parents: 819
diff changeset
2917 : let c = getline(".")[col(".") - 1]
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2918 : echo c
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2919 : exe "noremap <LeftMouse> <LeftMouse>r".c
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2920 : exe "noremap <LeftDrag> <LeftMouse>r".c
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2921 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2922 :noremap <RightMouse> <LeftMouse>:call GetPixel()<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2923 :set guicursor=n:hor20 " to see the color beneath the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2924 This turns the right button into a pipette and the left button into a pen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2925 It will work with XPM files that have one character per pixel only and you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2926 must not click outside of the pixel strings, but feel free to improve it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2927
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2928 It will look much better with a font in a quadratic cell size, e.g. for X: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2929 :set guifont=-*-clean-medium-r-*-*-8-*-*-*-*-80-*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2930
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2931 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2932 5. Defining a syntax *:syn-define* *E410*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2933
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2934 Vim understands three types of syntax items:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2935
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
2936 1. Keyword
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2937 It can only contain keyword characters, according to the 'iskeyword'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2938 option. It cannot contain other syntax items. It will only match with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2939 complete word (there are no keyword characters before or after the match).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2940 The keyword "if" would match in "if(a=b)", but not in "ifdef x", because
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2941 "(" is not a keyword character and "d" is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2942
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
2943 2. Match
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2944 This is a match with a single regexp pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2945
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
2946 3. Region
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2947 This starts at a match of the "start" regexp pattern and ends with a match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2948 with the "end" regexp pattern. Any other text can appear in between. A
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2949 "skip" regexp pattern can be used to avoid matching the "end" pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2950
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2951 Several syntax ITEMs can be put into one syntax GROUP. For a syntax group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2952 you can give highlighting attributes. For example, you could have an item
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2953 to define a "/* .. */" comment and another one that defines a "// .." comment,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2954 and put them both in the "Comment" group. You can then specify that a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2955 "Comment" will be in bold font and have a blue color. You are free to make
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2956 one highlight group for one syntax item, or put all items into one group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2957 This depends on how you want to specify your highlighting attributes. Putting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2958 each item in its own group results in having to specify the highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2959 for a lot of groups.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2960
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2961 Note that a syntax group and a highlight group are similar. For a highlight
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2962 group you will have given highlight attributes. These attributes will be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2963 for the syntax group with the same name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2964
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2965 In case more than one item matches at the same position, the one that was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2966 defined LAST wins. Thus you can override previously defined syntax items by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2967 using an item that matches the same text. But a keyword always goes before a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2968 match or region. And a keyword with matching case always goes before a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2969 keyword with ignoring case.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2970
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2971
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2972 PRIORITY *:syn-priority*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2973
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2974 When several syntax items may match, these rules are used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2975
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2976 1. When multiple Match or Region items start in the same position, the item
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2977 defined last has priority.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2978 2. A Keyword has priority over Match and Region items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2979 3. An item that starts in an earlier position has priority over items that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2980 start in later positions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2981
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2982
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2983 DEFINING CASE *:syn-case* *E390*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2984
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
2985 :sy[ntax] case [match | ignore]
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2986 This defines if the following ":syntax" commands will work with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2987 matching case, when using "match", or with ignoring case, when using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2988 "ignore". Note that any items before this are not affected, and all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2989 items until the next ":syntax case" command are affected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2990
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2991
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
2992 SPELL CHECKING *:syn-spell*
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
2993
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
2994 :sy[ntax] spell [toplevel | notoplevel | default]
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
2995 This defines where spell checking is to be done for text that is not
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
2996 in a syntax item:
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
2997
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
2998 toplevel: Text is spell checked.
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
2999 notoplevel: Text is not spell checked.
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3000 default: When there is a @Spell cluster no spell checking.
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3001
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3002 For text in syntax items use the @Spell and @NoSpell clusters
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3003 |spell-syntax|. When there is no @Spell and no @NoSpell cluster then
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3004 spell checking is done for "default" and "toplevel".
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3005
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3006 To activate spell checking the 'spell' option must be set.
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3007
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3008
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3009 DEFINING KEYWORDS *:syn-keyword*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3010
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3011 :sy[ntax] keyword {group-name} [{options}] {keyword} .. [{options}]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3012
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3013 This defines a number of keywords.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3014
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3015 {group-name} Is a syntax group name such as "Comment".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3016 [{options}] See |:syn-arguments| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3017 {keyword} .. Is a list of keywords which are part of this group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3018
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3019 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3020 :syntax keyword Type int long char
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3021 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3022 The {options} can be given anywhere in the line. They will apply to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3023 all keywords given, also for options that come after a keyword.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3024 These examples do exactly the same: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3025 :syntax keyword Type contained int long char
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3026 :syntax keyword Type int long contained char
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3027 :syntax keyword Type int long char contained
838
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
3028 < *E789*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3029 When you have a keyword with an optional tail, like Ex commands in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3030 Vim, you can put the optional characters inside [], to define all the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3031 variations at once: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3032 :syntax keyword vimCommand ab[breviate] n[ext]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3033 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3034 Don't forget that a keyword can only be recognized if all the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3035 characters are included in the 'iskeyword' option. If one character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3036 isn't, the keyword will never be recognized.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3037 Multi-byte characters can also be used. These do not have to be in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3038 'iskeyword'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3039
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3040 A keyword always has higher priority than a match or region, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3041 keyword is used if more than one item matches. Keywords do not nest
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3042 and a keyword can't contain anything else.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3043
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3044 Note that when you have a keyword that is the same as an option (even
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3045 one that isn't allowed here), you can not use it. Use a match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3046 instead.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3047
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3048 The maximum length of a keyword is 80 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3049
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3050 The same keyword can be defined multiple times, when its containment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3051 differs. For example, you can define the keyword once not contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3052 and use one highlight group, and once contained, and use a different
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
3053 highlight group. Example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3054 :syn keyword vimCommand tag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3055 :syn keyword vimSetting contained tag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3056 < When finding "tag" outside of any syntax item, the "vimCommand"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3057 highlight group is used. When finding "tag" in a syntax item that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3058 contains "vimSetting", the "vimSetting" group is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3059
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3060
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3061 DEFINING MATCHES *:syn-match*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3062
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3063 :sy[ntax] match {group-name} [{options}] [excludenl] {pattern} [{options}]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3064
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3065 This defines one match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3066
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3067 {group-name} A syntax group name such as "Comment".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3068 [{options}] See |:syn-arguments| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3069 [excludenl] Don't make a pattern with the end-of-line "$"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3070 extend a containing match or region. Must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3071 given before the pattern. |:syn-excludenl|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3072 {pattern} The search pattern that defines the match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3073 See |:syn-pattern| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3074 Note that the pattern may match more than one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3075 line, which makes the match depend on where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3076 Vim starts searching for the pattern. You
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3077 need to make sure syncing takes care of this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3078
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3079 Example (match a character constant): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3080 :syntax match Character /'.'/hs=s+1,he=e-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3081 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3082
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3083 DEFINING REGIONS *:syn-region* *:syn-start* *:syn-skip* *:syn-end*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3084 *E398* *E399*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3085 :sy[ntax] region {group-name} [{options}]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3086 [matchgroup={group-name}]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3087 [keepend]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3088 [extend]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3089 [excludenl]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3090 start={start_pattern} ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3091 [skip={skip_pattern}]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3092 end={end_pattern} ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3093 [{options}]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3094
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3095 This defines one region. It may span several lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3096
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3097 {group-name} A syntax group name such as "Comment".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3098 [{options}] See |:syn-arguments| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3099 [matchgroup={group-name}] The syntax group to use for the following
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3100 start or end pattern matches only. Not used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3101 for the text in between the matched start and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3102 end patterns. Use NONE to reset to not using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3103 a different group for the start or end match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3104 See |:syn-matchgroup|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3105 keepend Don't allow contained matches to go past a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3106 match with the end pattern. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3107 |:syn-keepend|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3108 extend Override a "keepend" for an item this region
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
3109 is contained in. See |:syn-extend|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3110 excludenl Don't make a pattern with the end-of-line "$"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3111 extend a containing match or item. Only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3112 useful for end patterns. Must be given before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3113 the patterns it applies to. |:syn-excludenl|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3114 start={start_pattern} The search pattern that defines the start of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3115 the region. See |:syn-pattern| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3116 skip={skip_pattern} The search pattern that defines text inside
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3117 the region where not to look for the end
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3118 pattern. See |:syn-pattern| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3119 end={end_pattern} The search pattern that defines the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3120 the region. See |:syn-pattern| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3121
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3122 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3123 :syntax region String start=+"+ skip=+\\"+ end=+"+
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3124 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3125 The start/skip/end patterns and the options can be given in any order.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3126 There can be zero or one skip pattern. There must be one or more
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3127 start and end patterns. This means that you can omit the skip
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3128 pattern, but you must give at least one start and one end pattern. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3129 is allowed to have white space before and after the equal sign
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3130 (although it mostly looks better without white space).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3131
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3132 When more than one start pattern is given, a match with one of these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3133 is sufficient. This means there is an OR relation between the start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3134 patterns. The last one that matches is used. The same is true for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3135 the end patterns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3136
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3137 The search for the end pattern starts right after the start pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3138 Offsets are not used for this. This implies that the match for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3139 end pattern will never overlap with the start pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3140
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3141 The skip and end pattern can match across line breaks, but since the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3142 search for the pattern can start in any line it often does not do what
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3143 you want. The skip pattern doesn't avoid a match of an end pattern in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3144 the next line. Use single-line patterns to avoid trouble.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3145
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3146 Note: The decision to start a region is only based on a matching start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3147 pattern. There is no check for a matching end pattern. This does NOT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3148 work: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3149 :syn region First start="(" end=":"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3150 :syn region Second start="(" end=";"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3151 < The Second always matches before the First (last defined pattern has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3152 higher priority). The Second region then continues until the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3153 ';', no matter if there is a ':' before it. Using a match does work: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3154 :syn match First "(\_.\{-}:"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3155 :syn match Second "(\_.\{-};"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3156 < This pattern matches any character or line break with "\_." and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3157 repeats that with "\{-}" (repeat as few as possible).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3158
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3159 *:syn-keepend*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3160 By default, a contained match can obscure a match for the end pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3161 This is useful for nesting. For example, a region that starts with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3162 "{" and ends with "}", can contain another region. An encountered "}"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3163 will then end the contained region, but not the outer region:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3164 { starts outer "{}" region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3165 { starts contained "{}" region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3166 } ends contained "{}" region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3167 } ends outer "{} region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3168 If you don't want this, the "keepend" argument will make the matching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3169 of an end pattern of the outer region also end any contained item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3170 This makes it impossible to nest the same region, but allows for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3171 contained items to highlight parts of the end pattern, without causing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3172 that to skip the match with the end pattern. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3173 :syn match vimComment +"[^"]\+$+
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3174 :syn region vimCommand start="set" end="$" contains=vimComment keepend
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3175 < The "keepend" makes the vimCommand always end at the end of the line,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3176 even though the contained vimComment includes a match with the <EOL>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3177
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3178 When "keepend" is not used, a match with an end pattern is retried
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3179 after each contained match. When "keepend" is included, the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3180 encountered match with an end pattern is used, truncating any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3181 contained matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3182 *:syn-extend*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3183 The "keepend" behavior can be changed by using the "extend" argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3184 When an item with "extend" is contained in an item that uses
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3185 "keepend", the "keepend" is ignored and the containing region will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3186 extended.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3187 This can be used to have some contained items extend a region while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3188 others don't. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3189
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3190 :syn region htmlRef start=+<a>+ end=+</a>+ keepend contains=htmlItem,htmlScript
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3191 :syn match htmlItem +<[^>]*>+ contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3192 :syn region htmlScript start=+<script+ end=+</script[^>]*>+ contained extend
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3193
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3194 < Here the htmlItem item does not make the htmlRef item continue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3195 further, it is only used to highlight the <> items. The htmlScript
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3196 item does extend the htmlRef item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3197
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3198 Another example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3199 :syn region xmlFold start="<a>" end="</a>" fold transparent keepend extend
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3200 < This defines a region with "keepend", so that its end cannot be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3201 changed by contained items, like when the "</a>" is matched to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3202 highlight it differently. But when the xmlFold region is nested (it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3203 includes itself), the "extend" applies, so that the "</a>" of a nested
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3204 region only ends that region, and not the one it is contained in.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3205
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3206 *:syn-excludenl*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3207 When a pattern for a match or end pattern of a region includes a '$'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3208 to match the end-of-line, it will make a region item that it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3209 contained in continue on the next line. For example, a match with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3210 "\\$" (backslash at the end of the line) can make a region continue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3211 that would normally stop at the end of the line. This is the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3212 behavior. If this is not wanted, there are two ways to avoid it:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3213 1. Use "keepend" for the containing item. This will keep all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3214 contained matches from extending the match or region. It can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3215 used when all contained items must not extend the containing item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3216 2. Use "excludenl" in the contained item. This will keep that match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3217 from extending the containing match or region. It can be used if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3218 only some contained items must not extend the containing item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3219 "excludenl" must be given before the pattern it applies to.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3220
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3221 *:syn-matchgroup*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3222 "matchgroup" can be used to highlight the start and/or end pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3223 differently than the body of the region. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3224 :syntax region String matchgroup=Quote start=+"+ skip=+\\"+ end=+"+
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3225 < This will highlight the quotes with the "Quote" group, and the text in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3226 between with the "String" group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3227 The "matchgroup" is used for all start and end patterns that follow,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3228 until the next "matchgroup". Use "matchgroup=NONE" to go back to not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3229 using a matchgroup.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3230
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3231 In a start or end pattern that is highlighted with "matchgroup" the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3232 contained items of the region are not used. This can be used to avoid
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3233 that a contained item matches in the start or end pattern match. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3234 using "transparent", this does not apply to a start or end pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3235 match that is highlighted with "matchgroup".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3236
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3237 Here is an example, which highlights three levels of parentheses in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3238 different colors: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3239 :sy region par1 matchgroup=par1 start=/(/ end=/)/ contains=par2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3240 :sy region par2 matchgroup=par2 start=/(/ end=/)/ contains=par3 contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3241 :sy region par3 matchgroup=par3 start=/(/ end=/)/ contains=par1 contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3242 :hi par1 ctermfg=red guifg=red
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3243 :hi par2 ctermfg=blue guifg=blue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3244 :hi par3 ctermfg=darkgreen guifg=darkgreen
2751
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3245 <
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3246 *E849*
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3247 The maximum number of syntax groups is 19999.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3248
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3249 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3250 6. :syntax arguments *:syn-arguments*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3251
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3252 The :syntax commands that define syntax items take a number of arguments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3253 The common ones are explained here. The arguments may be given in any order
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3254 and may be mixed with patterns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3255
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3256 Not all commands accept all arguments. This table shows which arguments
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3257 can not be used for all commands:
2520
6768ebd0bc04 Remove unused code.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2496
diff changeset
3258 *E395*
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3259 contains oneline fold display extend concealends~
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3260 :syntax keyword - - - - - -
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3261 :syntax match yes - yes yes yes -
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3262 :syntax region yes yes yes yes yes yes
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3263
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3264 These arguments can be used for all three commands:
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3265 conceal
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3266 cchar
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3267 contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3268 containedin
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3269 nextgroup
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3270 transparent
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3271 skipwhite
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3272 skipnl
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3273 skipempty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3274
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3275 conceal *conceal* *:syn-conceal*
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3276
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3277 When the "conceal" argument is given, the item is marked as concealable.
2269
fb627e94e6c6 Couple of small fixes for conceal feature. (Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2254
diff changeset
3278 Whether or not it is actually concealed depends on the value of the
2378
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2370
diff changeset
3279 'conceallevel' option. The 'concealcursor' option is used to decide whether
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2370
diff changeset
3280 concealable items in the current line are displayed unconcealed to be able to
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2370
diff changeset
3281 edit the line.
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3282
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3283 concealends *:syn-concealends*
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3284
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3285 When the "concealends" argument is given, the start and end matches of
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3286 the region, but not the contents of the region, are marked as concealable.
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3287 Whether or not they are actually concealed depends on the setting on the
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3288 'conceallevel' option. The ends of a region can only be concealed separately
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3289 in this way when they have their own highlighting via "matchgroup"
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3290
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3291 cchar *:syn-cchar*
2698
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2681
diff changeset
3292 *E844*
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3293 The "cchar" argument defines the character shown in place of the item
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3294 when it is concealed (setting "cchar" only makes sense when the conceal
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3295 argument is given.) If "cchar" is not set then the default conceal
2698
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2681
diff changeset
3296 character defined in the 'listchars' option is used. The character cannot be
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2681
diff changeset
3297 a control character such as Tab. Example: >
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3298 :syntax match Entity "&amp;" conceal cchar=&
2296
eb7be7b075a6 Support :browse for commands that use an error file argument. (Lech Lorens)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3299 See |hl-Conceal| for highlighting.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3300
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3301 contained *:syn-contained*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3302
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3303 When the "contained" argument is given, this item will not be recognized at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3304 the top level, but only when it is mentioned in the "contains" field of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3305 another match. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3306 :syntax keyword Todo TODO contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3307 :syntax match Comment "//.*" contains=Todo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3308
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3309
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3310 display *:syn-display*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3311
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3312 If the "display" argument is given, this item will be skipped when the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3313 detected highlighting will not be displayed. This will speed up highlighting,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3314 by skipping this item when only finding the syntax state for the text that is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3315 to be displayed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3316
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3317 Generally, you can use "display" for match and region items that meet these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3318 conditions:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3319 - The item does not continue past the end of a line. Example for C: A region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3320 for a "/*" comment can't contain "display", because it continues on the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3321 line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3322 - The item does not contain items that continue past the end of the line or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3323 make it continue on the next line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3324 - The item does not change the size of any item it is contained in. Example
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3325 for C: A match with "\\$" in a preprocessor match can't have "display",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3326 because it may make that preprocessor match shorter.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3327 - The item does not allow other items to match that didn't match otherwise,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3328 and that item may extend the match too far. Example for C: A match for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3329 "//" comment can't use "display", because a "/*" inside that comment would
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3330 match then and start a comment which extends past the end of the line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3331
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3332 Examples, for the C language, where "display" can be used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3333 - match with a number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3334 - match with a label
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3335
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3336
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3337 transparent *:syn-transparent*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3338
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3339 If the "transparent" argument is given, this item will not be highlighted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3340 itself, but will take the highlighting of the item it is contained in. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3341 is useful for syntax items that don't need any highlighting but are used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3342 only to skip over a part of the text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3343
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3344 The "contains=" argument is also inherited from the item it is contained in,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3345 unless a "contains" argument is given for the transparent item itself. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3346 avoid that unwanted items are contained, use "contains=NONE". Example, which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3347 highlights words in strings, but makes an exception for "vim": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3348 :syn match myString /'[^']*'/ contains=myWord,myVim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3349 :syn match myWord /\<[a-z]*\>/ contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3350 :syn match myVim /\<vim\>/ transparent contained contains=NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3351 :hi link myString String
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3352 :hi link myWord Comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3353 Since the "myVim" match comes after "myWord" it is the preferred match (last
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3354 match in the same position overrules an earlier one). The "transparent"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3355 argument makes the "myVim" match use the same highlighting as "myString". But
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3356 it does not contain anything. If the "contains=NONE" argument would be left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3357 out, then "myVim" would use the contains argument from myString and allow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3358 "myWord" to be contained, which will be highlighted as a Constant. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3359 happens because a contained match doesn't match inside itself in the same
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3360 position, thus the "myVim" match doesn't overrule the "myWord" match here.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3361
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3362 When you look at the colored text, it is like looking at layers of contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3363 items. The contained item is on top of the item it is contained in, thus you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3364 see the contained item. When a contained item is transparent, you can look
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3365 through, thus you see the item it is contained in. In a picture:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3366
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3367 look from here
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3368
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3369 | | | | | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3370 V V V V V V
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3371
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3372 xxxx yyy more contained items
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3373 .................... contained item (transparent)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3374 ============================= first item
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3375
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3376 The 'x', 'y' and '=' represent a highlighted syntax item. The '.' represent a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3377 transparent group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3378
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3379 What you see is:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3380
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3381 =======xxxx=======yyy========
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3382
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3383 Thus you look through the transparent "....".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3384
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3385
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3386 oneline *:syn-oneline*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3387
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3388 The "oneline" argument indicates that the region does not cross a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3389 boundary. It must match completely in the current line. However, when the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3390 region has a contained item that does cross a line boundary, it continues on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3391 the next line anyway. A contained item can be used to recognize a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3392 continuation pattern. But the "end" pattern must still match in the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3393 line, otherwise the region doesn't even start.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3394
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3395 When the start pattern includes a "\n" to match an end-of-line, the end
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3396 pattern must be found in the same line as where the start pattern ends. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3397 end pattern may also include an end-of-line. Thus the "oneline" argument
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3398 means that the end of the start pattern and the start of the end pattern must
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3399 be within one line. This can't be changed by a skip pattern that matches a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3400 line break.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3401
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3402
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3403 fold *:syn-fold*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3404
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3405 The "fold" argument makes the fold level increase by one for this item.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3406 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3407 :syn region myFold start="{" end="}" transparent fold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3408 :syn sync fromstart
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3409 :set foldmethod=syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3410 This will make each {} block form one fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3411
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3412 The fold will start on the line where the item starts, and end where the item
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3413 ends. If the start and end are within the same line, there is no fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3414 The 'foldnestmax' option limits the nesting of syntax folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3415 {not available when Vim was compiled without |+folding| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3416
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3417
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3418 *:syn-contains* *E405* *E406* *E407* *E408* *E409*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3419 contains={groupname},..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3420
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3421 The "contains" argument is followed by a list of syntax group names. These
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3422 groups will be allowed to begin inside the item (they may extend past the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3423 containing group's end). This allows for recursive nesting of matches and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3424 regions. If there is no "contains" argument, no groups will be contained in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3425 this item. The group names do not need to be defined before they can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3426 here.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3427
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3428 contains=ALL
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3429 If the only item in the contains list is "ALL", then all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3430 groups will be accepted inside the item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3431
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3432 contains=ALLBUT,{group-name},..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3433 If the first item in the contains list is "ALLBUT", then all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3434 groups will be accepted inside the item, except the ones that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3435 are listed. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3436 :syntax region Block start="{" end="}" ... contains=ALLBUT,Function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3437
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3438 contains=TOP
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3439 If the first item in the contains list is "TOP", then all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3440 groups will be accepted that don't have the "contained"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3441 argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3442 contains=TOP,{group-name},..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3443 Like "TOP", but excluding the groups that are listed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3444
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3445 contains=CONTAINED
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3446 If the first item in the contains list is "CONTAINED", then
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3447 all groups will be accepted that have the "contained"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3448 argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3449 contains=CONTAINED,{group-name},..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3450 Like "CONTAINED", but excluding the groups that are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3451 listed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3452
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3453
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3454 The {group-name} in the "contains" list can be a pattern. All group names
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3455 that match the pattern will be included (or excluded, if "ALLBUT" is used).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3456 The pattern cannot contain white space or a ','. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3457 ... contains=Comment.*,Keyw[0-3]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3458 The matching will be done at moment the syntax command is executed. Groups
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3459 that are defined later will not be matched. Also, if the current syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3460 command defines a new group, it is not matched. Be careful: When putting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3461 syntax commands in a file you can't rely on groups NOT being defined, because
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3462 the file may have been sourced before, and ":syn clear" doesn't remove the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3463 group names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3464
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3465 The contained groups will also match in the start and end patterns of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3466 region. If this is not wanted, the "matchgroup" argument can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3467 |:syn-matchgroup|. The "ms=" and "me=" offsets can be used to change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3468 region where contained items do match. Note that this may also limit the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3469 area that is highlighted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3470
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3471
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3472 containedin={groupname}... *:syn-containedin*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3473
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3474 The "containedin" argument is followed by a list of syntax group names. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3475 item will be allowed to begin inside these groups. This works as if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3476 containing item has a "contains=" argument that includes this item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3477
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3478 The {groupname}... can be used just like for "contains", as explained above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3479
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3480 This is useful when adding a syntax item afterwards. An item can be told to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3481 be included inside an already existing item, without changing the definition
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3482 of that item. For example, to highlight a word in a C comment after loading
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3483 the C syntax: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3484 :syn keyword myword HELP containedin=cComment contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3485 Note that "contained" is also used, to avoid that the item matches at the top
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3486 level.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3487
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3488 Matches for "containedin" are added to the other places where the item can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3489 appear. A "contains" argument may also be added as usual. Don't forget that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3490 keywords never contain another item, thus adding them to "containedin" won't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3491 work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3492
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3493
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3494 nextgroup={groupname},.. *:syn-nextgroup*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3495
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3496 The "nextgroup" argument is followed by a list of syntax group names,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3497 separated by commas (just like with "contains", so you can also use patterns).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3498
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3499 If the "nextgroup" argument is given, the mentioned syntax groups will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3500 tried for a match, after the match or region ends. If none of the groups have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3501 a match, highlighting continues normally. If there is a match, this group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3502 will be used, even when it is not mentioned in the "contains" field of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3503 current group. This is like giving the mentioned group priority over all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3504 other groups. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3505 :syntax match ccFoobar "Foo.\{-}Bar" contains=ccFoo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3506 :syntax match ccFoo "Foo" contained nextgroup=ccFiller
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3507 :syntax region ccFiller start="." matchgroup=ccBar end="Bar" contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3508
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3509 This will highlight "Foo" and "Bar" differently, and only when there is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3510 "Bar" after "Foo". In the text line below, "f" shows where ccFoo is used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3511 highlighting, and "bbb" where ccBar is used. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3512
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3513 Foo asdfasd Bar asdf Foo asdf Bar asdf
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3514 fff bbb fff bbb
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3515
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3516 Note the use of ".\{-}" to skip as little as possible until the next Bar.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3517 when ".*" would be used, the "asdf" in between "Bar" and "Foo" would be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3518 highlighted according to the "ccFoobar" group, because the ccFooBar match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3519 would include the first "Foo" and the last "Bar" in the line (see |pattern|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3520
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3521
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3522 skipwhite *:syn-skipwhite*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3523 skipnl *:syn-skipnl*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3524 skipempty *:syn-skipempty*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3525
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3526 These arguments are only used in combination with "nextgroup". They can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3527 used to allow the next group to match after skipping some text:
1275
d787f6c4c481 updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1224
diff changeset
3528 skipwhite skip over space and tab characters
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3529 skipnl skip over the end of a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3530 skipempty skip over empty lines (implies a "skipnl")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3531
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3532 When "skipwhite" is present, the white space is only skipped if there is no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3533 next group that matches the white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3534
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3535 When "skipnl" is present, the match with nextgroup may be found in the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3536 line. This only happens when the current item ends at the end of the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3537 line! When "skipnl" is not present, the nextgroup will only be found after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3538 the current item in the same line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3539
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3540 When skipping text while looking for a next group, the matches for other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3541 groups are ignored. Only when no next group matches, other items are tried
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3542 for a match again. This means that matching a next group and skipping white
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3543 space and <EOL>s has a higher priority than other items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3544
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3545 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3546 :syn match ifstart "\<if.*" nextgroup=ifline skipwhite skipempty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3547 :syn match ifline "[^ \t].*" nextgroup=ifline skipwhite skipempty contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3548 :syn match ifline "endif" contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3549 Note that the "[^ \t].*" match matches all non-white text. Thus it would also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3550 match "endif". Therefore the "endif" match is put last, so that it takes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3551 precedence.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3552 Note that this example doesn't work for nested "if"s. You need to add
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3553 "contains" arguments to make that work (omitted for simplicity of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3554 example).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3555
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3556 IMPLICIT CONCEAL *:syn-conceal-implicit*
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3557
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3558 :sy[ntax] conceal [on|off]
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3559 This defines if the following ":syntax" commands will define keywords,
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3560 matches or regions with the "conceal" flag set. After ":syn conceal
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3561 on", all subsequent ":syn keyword", ":syn match" or ":syn region"
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3562 defined will have the "conceal" flag set implicitly. ":syn conceal
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3563 off" returns to the normal state where the "conceal" flag must be
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3564 given explicitly.
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3565
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3566 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3567 7. Syntax patterns *:syn-pattern* *E401* *E402*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3568
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3569 In the syntax commands, a pattern must be surrounded by two identical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3570 characters. This is like it works for the ":s" command. The most common to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3571 use is the double quote. But if the pattern contains a double quote, you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3572 use another character that is not used in the pattern. Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3573 :syntax region Comment start="/\*" end="\*/"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3574 :syntax region String start=+"+ end=+"+ skip=+\\"+
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3575
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3576 See |pattern| for the explanation of what a pattern is. Syntax patterns are
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3577 always interpreted like the 'magic' option is set, no matter what the actual
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3578 value of 'magic' is. And the patterns are interpreted like the 'l' flag is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3579 not included in 'cpoptions'. This was done to make syntax files portable and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3580 independent of 'compatible' and 'magic' settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3581
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3582 Try to avoid patterns that can match an empty string, such as "[a-z]*".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3583 This slows down the highlighting a lot, because it matches everywhere.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3584
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3585 *:syn-pattern-offset*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3586 The pattern can be followed by a character offset. This can be used to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3587 change the highlighted part, and to change the text area included in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3588 match or region (which only matters when trying to match other items). Both
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3589 are relative to the matched pattern. The character offset for a skip
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3590 pattern can be used to tell where to continue looking for an end pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3591
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3592 The offset takes the form of "{what}={offset}"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3593 The {what} can be one of seven strings:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3594
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3595 ms Match Start offset for the start of the matched text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3596 me Match End offset for the end of the matched text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3597 hs Highlight Start offset for where the highlighting starts
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3598 he Highlight End offset for where the highlighting ends
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3599 rs Region Start offset for where the body of a region starts
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3600 re Region End offset for where the body of a region ends
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3601 lc Leading Context offset past "leading context" of pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3602
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3603 The {offset} can be:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3604
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3605 s start of the matched pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3606 s+{nr} start of the matched pattern plus {nr} chars to the right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3607 s-{nr} start of the matched pattern plus {nr} chars to the left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3608 e end of the matched pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3609 e+{nr} end of the matched pattern plus {nr} chars to the right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3610 e-{nr} end of the matched pattern plus {nr} chars to the left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3611 {nr} (for "lc" only): start matching {nr} chars to the left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3612
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3613 Examples: "ms=s+1", "hs=e-2", "lc=3".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3614
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3615 Although all offsets are accepted after any pattern, they are not always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3616 meaningful. This table shows which offsets are actually used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3617
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3618 ms me hs he rs re lc ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3619 match item yes yes yes yes - - yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3620 region item start yes - yes - yes - yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3621 region item skip - yes - - - - yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3622 region item end - yes - yes - yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3623
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3624 Offsets can be concatenated, with a ',' in between. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3625 :syn match String /"[^"]*"/hs=s+1,he=e-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3626 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3627 some "string" text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3628 ^^^^^^ highlighted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3629
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3630 Notes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3631 - There must be no white space between the pattern and the character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3632 offset(s).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3633 - The highlighted area will never be outside of the matched text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3634 - A negative offset for an end pattern may not always work, because the end
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3635 pattern may be detected when the highlighting should already have stopped.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
3636 - Before Vim 7.2 the offsets were counted in bytes instead of characters.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
3637 This didn't work well for multi-byte characters, so it was changed with the
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
3638 Vim 7.2 release.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3639 - The start of a match cannot be in a line other than where the pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3640 matched. This doesn't work: "a\nb"ms=e. You can make the highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3641 start in another line, this does work: "a\nb"hs=e.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3642
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3643 Example (match a comment but don't highlight the /* and */): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3644 :syntax region Comment start="/\*"hs=e+1 end="\*/"he=s-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3645 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3646 /* this is a comment */
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3647 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ highlighted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3648
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3649 A more complicated Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3650 :syn region Exa matchgroup=Foo start="foo"hs=s+2,rs=e+2 matchgroup=Bar end="bar"me=e-1,he=e-1,re=s-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3651 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3652 abcfoostringbarabc
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3653 mmmmmmmmmmm match
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 572
diff changeset
3654 sssrrreee highlight start/region/end ("Foo", "Exa" and "Bar")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3655
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3656 Leading context *:syn-lc* *:syn-leading* *:syn-context*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3657
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3658 Note: This is an obsolete feature, only included for backwards compatibility
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3659 with previous Vim versions. It's now recommended to use the |/\@<=| construct
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3660 in the pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3661
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3662 The "lc" offset specifies leading context -- a part of the pattern that must
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3663 be present, but is not considered part of the match. An offset of "lc=n" will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3664 cause Vim to step back n columns before attempting the pattern match, allowing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3665 characters which have already been matched in previous patterns to also be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3666 used as leading context for this match. This can be used, for instance, to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3667 specify that an "escaping" character must not precede the match: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3668
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3669 :syn match ZNoBackslash "[^\\]z"ms=s+1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3670 :syn match WNoBackslash "[^\\]w"lc=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3671 :syn match Underline "_\+"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3672 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3673 ___zzzz ___wwww
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3674 ^^^ ^^^ matches Underline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3675 ^ ^ matches ZNoBackslash
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3676 ^^^^ matches WNoBackslash
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3677
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3678 The "ms" offset is automatically set to the same value as the "lc" offset,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3679 unless you set "ms" explicitly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3680
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3681
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3682 Multi-line patterns *:syn-multi-line*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3683
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3684 The patterns can include "\n" to match an end-of-line. Mostly this works as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3685 expected, but there are a few exceptions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3686
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3687 When using a start pattern with an offset, the start of the match is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3688 allowed to start in a following line. The highlighting can start in a
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
3689 following line though. Using the "\zs" item also requires that the start of
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
3690 the match doesn't move to another line.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3691
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3692 The skip pattern can include the "\n", but the search for an end pattern will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3693 continue in the first character of the next line, also when that character is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3694 matched by the skip pattern. This is because redrawing may start in any line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3695 halfway a region and there is no check if the skip pattern started in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3696 previous line. For example, if the skip pattern is "a\nb" and an end pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3697 is "b", the end pattern does match in the second line of this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3698 x x a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3699 b x x
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3700 Generally this means that the skip pattern should not match any characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3701 after the "\n".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3702
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3703
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3704 External matches *:syn-ext-match*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3705
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3706 These extra regular expression items are available in region patterns:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3707
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3708 */\z(* */\z(\)* *E50* *E52*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3709 \z(\) Marks the sub-expression as "external", meaning that it is can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3710 be accessed from another pattern match. Currently only usable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3711 in defining a syntax region start pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3712
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3713 */\z1* */\z2* */\z3* */\z4* */\z5*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3714 \z1 ... \z9 */\z6* */\z7* */\z8* */\z9* *E66* *E67*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3715 Matches the same string that was matched by the corresponding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3716 sub-expression in a previous start pattern match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3717
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3718 Sometimes the start and end patterns of a region need to share a common
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3719 sub-expression. A common example is the "here" document in Perl and many Unix
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3720 shells. This effect can be achieved with the "\z" special regular expression
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3721 items, which marks a sub-expression as "external", in the sense that it can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3722 referenced from outside the pattern in which it is defined. The here-document
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3723 example, for instance, can be done like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3724 :syn region hereDoc start="<<\z(\I\i*\)" end="^\z1$"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3725
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3726 As can be seen here, the \z actually does double duty. In the start pattern,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3727 it marks the "\(\I\i*\)" sub-expression as external; in the end pattern, it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3728 changes the \1 back-reference into an external reference referring to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3729 first external sub-expression in the start pattern. External references can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3730 also be used in skip patterns: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3731 :syn region foo start="start \(\I\i*\)" skip="not end \z1" end="end \z1"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3732
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3733 Note that normal and external sub-expressions are completely orthogonal and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3734 indexed separately; for instance, if the pattern "\z(..\)\(..\)" is applied
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3735 to the string "aabb", then \1 will refer to "bb" and \z1 will refer to "aa".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3736 Note also that external sub-expressions cannot be accessed as back-references
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3737 within the same pattern like normal sub-expressions. If you want to use one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3738 sub-expression as both a normal and an external sub-expression, you can nest
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3739 the two, as in "\(\z(...\)\)".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3740
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3741 Note that only matches within a single line can be used. Multi-line matches
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3742 cannot be referred to.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3743
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3744 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3745 8. Syntax clusters *:syn-cluster* *E400*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3746
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3747 :sy[ntax] cluster {cluster-name} [contains={group-name}..]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3748 [add={group-name}..]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3749 [remove={group-name}..]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3750
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3751 This command allows you to cluster a list of syntax groups together under a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3752 single name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3753
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3754 contains={group-name}..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3755 The cluster is set to the specified list of groups.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3756 add={group-name}..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3757 The specified groups are added to the cluster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3758 remove={group-name}..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3759 The specified groups are removed from the cluster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3760
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3761 A cluster so defined may be referred to in a contains=.., containedin=..,
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3762 nextgroup=.., add=.. or remove=.. list with a "@" prefix. You can also use
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3763 this notation to implicitly declare a cluster before specifying its contents.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3764
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3765 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3766 :syntax match Thing "# [^#]\+ #" contains=@ThingMembers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3767 :syntax cluster ThingMembers contains=ThingMember1,ThingMember2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3768
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3769 As the previous example suggests, modifications to a cluster are effectively
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3770 retroactive; the membership of the cluster is checked at the last minute, so
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3771 to speak: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3772 :syntax keyword A aaa
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3773 :syntax keyword B bbb
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3774 :syntax cluster AandB contains=A
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3775 :syntax match Stuff "( aaa bbb )" contains=@AandB
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3776 :syntax cluster AandB add=B " now both keywords are matched in Stuff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3777
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3778 This also has implications for nested clusters: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3779 :syntax keyword A aaa
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3780 :syntax keyword B bbb
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3781 :syntax cluster SmallGroup contains=B
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3782 :syntax cluster BigGroup contains=A,@SmallGroup
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3783 :syntax match Stuff "( aaa bbb )" contains=@BigGroup
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3784 :syntax cluster BigGroup remove=B " no effect, since B isn't in BigGroup
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3785 :syntax cluster SmallGroup remove=B " now bbb isn't matched within Stuff
2751
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3786 <
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3787 *E848*
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3788 The maximum number of clusters is 9767.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3789
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3790 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3791 9. Including syntax files *:syn-include* *E397*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3792
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3793 It is often useful for one language's syntax file to include a syntax file for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3794 a related language. Depending on the exact relationship, this can be done in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3795 two different ways:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3796
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3797 - If top-level syntax items in the included syntax file are to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3798 allowed at the top level in the including syntax, you can simply use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3799 the |:runtime| command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3800
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3801 " In cpp.vim:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3802 :runtime! syntax/c.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3803 :unlet b:current_syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3804
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3805 < - If top-level syntax items in the included syntax file are to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3806 contained within a region in the including syntax, you can use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3807 ":syntax include" command:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3808
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3809 :sy[ntax] include [@{grouplist-name}] {file-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3810
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3811 All syntax items declared in the included file will have the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3812 "contained" flag added. In addition, if a group list is specified,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3813 all top-level syntax items in the included file will be added to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3814 that list. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3815
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3816 " In perl.vim:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3817 :syntax include @Pod <sfile>:p:h/pod.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3818 :syntax region perlPOD start="^=head" end="^=cut" contains=@Pod
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3819 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3820 When {file-name} is an absolute path (starts with "/", "c:", "$VAR"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3821 or "<sfile>") that file is sourced. When it is a relative path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3822 (e.g., "syntax/pod.vim") the file is searched for in 'runtimepath'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3823 All matching files are loaded. Using a relative path is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3824 recommended, because it allows a user to replace the included file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3825 with his own version, without replacing the file that does the ":syn
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3826 include".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3827
2751
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3828 *E847*
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3829 The maximum number of includes is 999.
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3830
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3831 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3832 10. Synchronizing *:syn-sync* *E403* *E404*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3833
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3834 Vim wants to be able to start redrawing in any position in the document. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3835 make this possible it needs to know the syntax state at the position where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3836 redrawing starts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3837
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3838 :sy[ntax] sync [ccomment [group-name] | minlines={N} | ...]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3839
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3840 There are four ways to synchronize:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3841 1. Always parse from the start of the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3842 |:syn-sync-first|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3843 2. Based on C-style comments. Vim understands how C-comments work and can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3844 figure out if the current line starts inside or outside a comment.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3845 |:syn-sync-second|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3846 3. Jumping back a certain number of lines and start parsing there.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3847 |:syn-sync-third|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3848 4. Searching backwards in the text for a pattern to sync on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3849 |:syn-sync-fourth|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3850
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3851 *:syn-sync-maxlines* *:syn-sync-minlines*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3852 For the last three methods, the line range where the parsing can start is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3853 limited by "minlines" and "maxlines".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3854
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3855 If the "minlines={N}" argument is given, the parsing always starts at least
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3856 that many lines backwards. This can be used if the parsing may take a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3857 lines before it's correct, or when it's not possible to use syncing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3858
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3859 If the "maxlines={N}" argument is given, the number of lines that are searched
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3860 for a comment or syncing pattern is restricted to N lines backwards (after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3861 adding "minlines"). This is useful if you have few things to sync on and a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3862 slow machine. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3863 :syntax sync ccomment maxlines=500
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3864 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3865 *:syn-sync-linebreaks*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3866 When using a pattern that matches multiple lines, a change in one line may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3867 cause a pattern to no longer match in a previous line. This means has to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3868 start above where the change was made. How many lines can be specified with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3869 the "linebreaks" argument. For example, when a pattern may include one line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3870 break use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3871 :syntax sync linebreaks=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3872 The result is that redrawing always starts at least one line before where a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3873 change was made. The default value for "linebreaks" is zero. Usually the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3874 value for "minlines" is bigger than "linebreaks".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3875
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3876
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3877 First syncing method: *:syn-sync-first*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3878 >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3879 :syntax sync fromstart
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3880
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3881 The file will be parsed from the start. This makes syntax highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3882 accurate, but can be slow for long files. Vim caches previously parsed text,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3883 so that it's only slow when parsing the text for the first time. However,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3884 when making changes some part of the next needs to be parsed again (worst
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3885 case: to the end of the file).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3886
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3887 Using "fromstart" is equivalent to using "minlines" with a very large number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3888
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3889
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3890 Second syncing method: *:syn-sync-second* *:syn-sync-ccomment*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3891
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3892 For the second method, only the "ccomment" argument needs to be given.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3893 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3894 :syntax sync ccomment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3895
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3896 When Vim finds that the line where displaying starts is inside a C-style
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3897 comment, the last region syntax item with the group-name "Comment" will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3898 used. This requires that there is a region with the group-name "Comment"!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3899 An alternate group name can be specified, for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3900 :syntax sync ccomment javaComment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3901 This means that the last item specified with "syn region javaComment" will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3902 used for the detected C comment region. This only works properly if that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3903 region does have a start pattern "\/*" and an end pattern "*\/".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3904
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3905 The "maxlines" argument can be used to restrict the search to a number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3906 lines. The "minlines" argument can be used to at least start a number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3907 lines back (e.g., for when there is some construct that only takes a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3908 lines, but it hard to sync on).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3909
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3910 Note: Syncing on a C comment doesn't work properly when strings are used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3911 that cross a line and contain a "*/". Since letting strings cross a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3912 is a bad programming habit (many compilers give a warning message), and the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3913 chance of a "*/" appearing inside a comment is very small, this restriction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3914 is hardly ever noticed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3915
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3916
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3917 Third syncing method: *:syn-sync-third*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3918
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3919 For the third method, only the "minlines={N}" argument needs to be given.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3920 Vim will subtract {N} from the line number and start parsing there. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3921 means {N} extra lines need to be parsed, which makes this method a bit slower.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3922 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3923 :syntax sync minlines=50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3924
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3925 "lines" is equivalent to "minlines" (used by older versions).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3926
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3927
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3928 Fourth syncing method: *:syn-sync-fourth*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3929
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3930 The idea is to synchronize on the end of a few specific regions, called a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3931 sync pattern. Only regions can cross lines, so when we find the end of some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3932 region, we might be able to know in which syntax item we are. The search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3933 starts in the line just above the one where redrawing starts. From there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3934 the search continues backwards in the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3935
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3936 This works just like the non-syncing syntax items. You can use contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3937 matches, nextgroup, etc. But there are a few differences:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3938 - Keywords cannot be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3939 - The syntax items with the "sync" keyword form a completely separated group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3940 of syntax items. You can't mix syncing groups and non-syncing groups.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3941 - The matching works backwards in the buffer (line by line), instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3942 forwards.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3943 - A line continuation pattern can be given. It is used to decide which group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3944 of lines need to be searched like they were one line. This means that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3945 search for a match with the specified items starts in the first of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3946 consecutive that contain the continuation pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3947 - When using "nextgroup" or "contains", this only works within one line (or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3948 group of continued lines).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3949 - When using a region, it must start and end in the same line (or group of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3950 continued lines). Otherwise the end is assumed to be at the end of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3951 line (or group of continued lines).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3952 - When a match with a sync pattern is found, the rest of the line (or group of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3953 continued lines) is searched for another match. The last match is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3954 This is used when a line can contain both the start end the end of a region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3955 (e.g., in a C-comment like /* this */, the last "*/" is used).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3956
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3957 There are two ways how a match with a sync pattern can be used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3958 1. Parsing for highlighting starts where redrawing starts (and where the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3959 search for the sync pattern started). The syntax group that is expected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3960 to be valid there must be specified. This works well when the regions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3961 that cross lines cannot contain other regions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3962 2. Parsing for highlighting continues just after the match. The syntax group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3963 that is expected to be present just after the match must be specified.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3964 This can be used when the previous method doesn't work well. It's much
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3965 slower, because more text needs to be parsed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3966 Both types of sync patterns can be used at the same time.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3967
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3968 Besides the sync patterns, other matches and regions can be specified, to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3969 avoid finding unwanted matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3970
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3971 [The reason that the sync patterns are given separately, is that mostly the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3972 search for the sync point can be much simpler than figuring out the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3973 highlighting. The reduced number of patterns means it will go (much)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3974 faster.]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3975
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3976 *syn-sync-grouphere* *E393* *E394*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3977 :syntax sync match {sync-group-name} grouphere {group-name} "pattern" ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3978
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3979 Define a match that is used for syncing. {group-name} is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3980 name of a syntax group that follows just after the match. Parsing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3981 of the text for highlighting starts just after the match. A region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3982 must exist for this {group-name}. The first one defined will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3983 "NONE" can be used for when there is no syntax group after the match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3984
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3985 *syn-sync-groupthere*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3986 :syntax sync match {sync-group-name} groupthere {group-name} "pattern" ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3987
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3988 Like "grouphere", but {group-name} is the name of a syntax group that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3989 is to be used at the start of the line where searching for the sync
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3990 point started. The text between the match and the start of the sync
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3991 pattern searching is assumed not to change the syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3992 For example, in C you could search backwards for "/*" and "*/". If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3993 "/*" is found first, you know that you are inside a comment, so the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3994 "groupthere" is "cComment". If "*/" is found first, you know that you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3995 are not in a comment, so the "groupthere" is "NONE". (in practice
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3996 it's a bit more complicated, because the "/*" and "*/" could appear
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3997 inside a string. That's left as an exercise to the reader...).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3998
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3999 :syntax sync match ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4000 :syntax sync region ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4001
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4002 Without a "groupthere" argument. Define a region or match that is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4003 skipped while searching for a sync point.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4004
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
4005 *syn-sync-linecont*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4006 :syntax sync linecont {pattern}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4007
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4008 When {pattern} matches in a line, it is considered to continue in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4009 the next line. This means that the search for a sync point will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4010 consider the lines to be concatenated.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4011
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4012 If the "maxlines={N}" argument is given too, the number of lines that are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4013 searched for a match is restricted to N. This is useful if you have very
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4014 few things to sync on and a slow machine. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4015 :syntax sync maxlines=100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4016
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4017 You can clear all sync settings with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4018 :syntax sync clear
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4019
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4020 You can clear specific sync patterns with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4021 :syntax sync clear {sync-group-name} ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4022
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4023 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4024 11. Listing syntax items *:syntax* *:sy* *:syn* *:syn-list*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4025
534
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
4026 This command lists all the syntax items: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4027
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4028 :sy[ntax] [list]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4029
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4030 To show the syntax items for one syntax group: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4031
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4032 :sy[ntax] list {group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4033
2581
e8a482a7fa6c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
4034 To list the syntax groups in one cluster: *E392* >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4035
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4036 :sy[ntax] list @{cluster-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4037
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4038 See above for other arguments for the ":syntax" command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4039
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4040 Note that the ":syntax" command can be abbreviated to ":sy", although ":syn"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4041 is mostly used, because it looks better.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4042
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4043 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4044 12. Highlight command *:highlight* *:hi* *E28* *E411* *E415*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4045
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4046 There are three types of highlight groups:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4047 - The ones used for specific languages. For these the name starts with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4048 name of the language. Many of these don't have any attributes, but are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4049 linked to a group of the second type.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4050 - The ones used for all syntax languages.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4051 - The ones used for the 'highlight' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4052 *hitest.vim*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4053 You can see all the groups currently active with this command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4054 :so $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/hitest.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4055 This will open a new window containing all highlight group names, displayed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4056 in their own color.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4057
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4058 *:colo* *:colorscheme* *E185*
2152
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4059 :colo[rscheme] Output the name of the currently active color scheme.
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4060 This is basically the same as >
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4061 :echo g:colors_name
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4062 < In case g:colors_name has not been defined :colo will
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4063 output "default". When compiled without the |+eval|
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4064 feature it will output "unknown".
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4065
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4066 :colo[rscheme] {name} Load color scheme {name}. This searches 'runtimepath'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4067 for the file "colors/{name}.vim. The first one that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4068 is found is loaded.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
4069 To see the name of the currently active color scheme: >
2152
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4070 :colo
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4071 < The name is also stored in the g:colors_name variable.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
4072 Doesn't work recursively, thus you can't use
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4073 ":colorscheme" in a color scheme script.
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 9
diff changeset
4074 After the color scheme has been loaded the
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 9
diff changeset
4075 |ColorScheme| autocommand event is triggered.
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
4076 For info about writing a colorscheme file: >
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
4077 :edit $VIMRUNTIME/colors/README.txt
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4078
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4079 :hi[ghlight] List all the current highlight groups that have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4080 attributes set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4081
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4082 :hi[ghlight] {group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4083 List one highlight group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4084
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4085 :hi[ghlight] clear Reset all highlighting to the defaults. Removes all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4086 highlighting for groups added by the user!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4087 Uses the current value of 'background' to decide which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4088 default colors to use.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4089
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4090 :hi[ghlight] clear {group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4091 :hi[ghlight] {group-name} NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4092 Disable the highlighting for one highlight group. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4093 is _not_ set back to the default colors.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4094
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4095 :hi[ghlight] [default] {group-name} {key}={arg} ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4096 Add a highlight group, or change the highlighting for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4097 an existing group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4098 See |highlight-args| for the {key}={arg} arguments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4099 See |:highlight-default| for the optional [default]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4100 argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4101
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4102 Normally a highlight group is added once when starting up. This sets the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4103 default values for the highlighting. After that, you can use additional
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4104 highlight commands to change the arguments that you want to set to non-default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4105 values. The value "NONE" can be used to switch the value off or go back to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4106 the default value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4107
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4108 A simple way to change colors is with the |:colorscheme| command. This loads
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4109 a file with ":highlight" commands such as this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4110
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4111 :hi Comment gui=bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4112
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4113 Note that all settings that are not included remain the same, only the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4114 specified field is used, and settings are merged with previous ones. So, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4115 result is like this single command has been used: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4116 :hi Comment term=bold ctermfg=Cyan guifg=#80a0ff gui=bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4117 <
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
4118 *:highlight-verbose*
448
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
4119 When listing a highlight group and 'verbose' is non-zero, the listing will
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
4120 also tell where it was last set. Example: >
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
4121 :verbose hi Comment
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
4122 < Comment xxx term=bold ctermfg=4 guifg=Blue ~
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
4123 Last set from /home/mool/vim/vim7/runtime/syntax/syncolor.vim ~
448
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
4124
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 481
diff changeset
4125 When ":hi clear" is used then the script where this command is used will be
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 481
diff changeset
4126 mentioned for the default values. See |:verbose-cmd| for more information.
448
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
4127
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4128 *highlight-args* *E416* *E417* *E423*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4129 There are three types of terminals for highlighting:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4130 term a normal terminal (vt100, xterm)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4131 cterm a color terminal (MS-DOS console, color-xterm, these have the "Co"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4132 termcap entry)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4133 gui the GUI
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4134
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4135 For each type the highlighting can be given. This makes it possible to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4136 the same syntax file on all terminals, and use the optimal highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4137
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4138 1. highlight arguments for normal terminals
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4139
301
006e9c8a6a8a updated for version 7.0079
vimboss
parents: 279
diff changeset
4140 *bold* *underline* *undercurl*
006e9c8a6a8a updated for version 7.0079
vimboss
parents: 279
diff changeset
4141 *inverse* *italic* *standout*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4142 term={attr-list} *attr-list* *highlight-term* *E418*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4143 attr-list is a comma separated list (without spaces) of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4144 following items (in any order):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4145 bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4146 underline
217
89114a6baf3c updated for version 7.0061
vimboss
parents: 169
diff changeset
4147 undercurl not always available
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4148 reverse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4149 inverse same as reverse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4150 italic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4151 standout
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4152 NONE no attributes used (used to reset it)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4153
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4154 Note that "bold" can be used here and by using a bold font. They
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4155 have the same effect.
217
89114a6baf3c updated for version 7.0061
vimboss
parents: 169
diff changeset
4156 "undercurl" is a curly underline. When "undercurl" is not possible
89114a6baf3c updated for version 7.0061
vimboss
parents: 169
diff changeset
4157 then "underline" is used. In general "undercurl" is only available in
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
4158 the GUI. The color is set with |highlight-guisp|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4159
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4160 start={term-list} *highlight-start* *E422*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4161 stop={term-list} *term-list* *highlight-stop*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4162 These lists of terminal codes can be used to get
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4163 non-standard attributes on a terminal.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4164
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4165 The escape sequence specified with the "start" argument
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4166 is written before the characters in the highlighted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4167 area. It can be anything that you want to send to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4168 terminal to highlight this area. The escape sequence
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4169 specified with the "stop" argument is written after the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4170 highlighted area. This should undo the "start" argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4171 Otherwise the screen will look messed up.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4172
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4173 The {term-list} can have two forms:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4174
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4175 1. A string with escape sequences.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4176 This is any string of characters, except that it can't start with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4177 "t_" and blanks are not allowed. The <> notation is recognized
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4178 here, so you can use things like "<Esc>" and "<Space>". Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4179 start=<Esc>[27h;<Esc>[<Space>r;
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4180
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4181 2. A list of terminal codes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4182 Each terminal code has the form "t_xx", where "xx" is the name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4183 the termcap entry. The codes have to be separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4184 White space is not allowed. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4185 start=t_C1,t_BL
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4186 The terminal codes must exist for this to work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4187
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4188
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4189 2. highlight arguments for color terminals
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4190
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4191 cterm={attr-list} *highlight-cterm*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4192 See above for the description of {attr-list} |attr-list|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4193 The "cterm" argument is likely to be different from "term", when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4194 colors are used. For example, in a normal terminal comments could
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4195 be underlined, in a color terminal they can be made Blue.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4196 Note: Many terminals (e.g., DOS console) can't mix these attributes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4197 with coloring. Use only one of "cterm=" OR "ctermfg=" OR "ctermbg=".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4198
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4199 ctermfg={color-nr} *highlight-ctermfg* *E421*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4200 ctermbg={color-nr} *highlight-ctermbg*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4201 The {color-nr} argument is a color number. Its range is zero to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4202 (not including) the number given by the termcap entry "Co".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4203 The actual color with this number depends on the type of terminal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4204 and its settings. Sometimes the color also depends on the settings of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4205 "cterm". For example, on some systems "cterm=bold ctermfg=3" gives
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4206 another color, on others you just get color 3.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4207
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4208 For an xterm this depends on your resources, and is a bit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4209 unpredictable. See your xterm documentation for the defaults. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4210 colors for a color-xterm can be changed from the .Xdefaults file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4211 Unfortunately this means that it's not possible to get the same colors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4212 for each user. See |xterm-color| for info about color xterms.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4213
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4214 The MSDOS standard colors are fixed (in a console window), so these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4215 have been used for the names. But the meaning of color names in X11
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4216 are fixed, so these color settings have been used, to make the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4217 highlighting settings portable (complicated, isn't it?). The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4218 following names are recognized, with the color number used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4219
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4220 *cterm-colors*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4221 NR-16 NR-8 COLOR NAME ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4222 0 0 Black
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4223 1 4 DarkBlue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4224 2 2 DarkGreen
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4225 3 6 DarkCyan
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4226 4 1 DarkRed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4227 5 5 DarkMagenta
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4228 6 3 Brown, DarkYellow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4229 7 7 LightGray, LightGrey, Gray, Grey
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4230 8 0* DarkGray, DarkGrey
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4231 9 4* Blue, LightBlue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4232 10 2* Green, LightGreen
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4233 11 6* Cyan, LightCyan
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4234 12 1* Red, LightRed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4235 13 5* Magenta, LightMagenta
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4236 14 3* Yellow, LightYellow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4237 15 7* White
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4238
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4239 The number under "NR-16" is used for 16-color terminals ('t_Co'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4240 greater than or equal to 16). The number under "NR-8" is used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4241 8-color terminals ('t_Co' less than 16). The '*' indicates that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4242 bold attribute is set for ctermfg. In many 8-color terminals (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4243 "linux"), this causes the bright colors to appear. This doesn't work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4244 for background colors! Without the '*' the bold attribute is removed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4245 If you want to set the bold attribute in a different way, put a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4246 "cterm=" argument AFTER the "ctermfg=" or "ctermbg=" argument. Or use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4247 a number instead of a color name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4248
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4249 The case of the color names is ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4250 Note that for 16 color ansi style terminals (including xterms), the
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
4251 numbers in the NR-8 column is used. Here '*' means 'add 8' so that Blue
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4252 is 12, DarkGray is 8 etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4253
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4254 Note that for some color terminals these names may result in the wrong
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4255 colors!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4256
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4257 *:hi-normal-cterm*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4258 When setting the "ctermfg" or "ctermbg" colors for the Normal group,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4259 these will become the colors used for the non-highlighted text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4260 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4261 :highlight Normal ctermfg=grey ctermbg=darkblue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4262 < When setting the "ctermbg" color for the Normal group, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4263 'background' option will be adjusted automatically. This causes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4264 highlight groups that depend on 'background' to change! This means
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4265 you should set the colors for Normal first, before setting other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4266 colors.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4267 When a colorscheme is being used, changing 'background' causes it to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4268 be reloaded, which may reset all colors (including Normal). First
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
4269 delete the "g:colors_name" variable when you don't want this.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4270
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4271 When you have set "ctermfg" or "ctermbg" for the Normal group, Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4272 needs to reset the color when exiting. This is done with the "op"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4273 termcap entry |t_op|. If this doesn't work correctly, try setting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4274 't_op' option in your .vimrc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4275 *E419* *E420*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4276 When Vim knows the normal foreground and background colors, "fg" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4277 "bg" can be used as color names. This only works after setting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4278 colors for the Normal group and for the MS-DOS console. Example, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4279 reverse video: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4280 :highlight Visual ctermfg=bg ctermbg=fg
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4281 < Note that the colors are used that are valid at the moment this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4282 command are given. If the Normal group colors are changed later, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4283 "fg" and "bg" colors will not be adjusted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4284
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4285
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4286 3. highlight arguments for the GUI
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4287
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4288 gui={attr-list} *highlight-gui*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4289 These give the attributes to use in the GUI mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4290 See |attr-list| for a description.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4291 Note that "bold" can be used here and by using a bold font. They
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4292 have the same effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4293 Note that the attributes are ignored for the "Normal" group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4294
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4295 font={font-name} *highlight-font*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4296 font-name is the name of a font, as it is used on the system Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4297 runs on. For X11 this is a complicated name, for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4298 font=-misc-fixed-bold-r-normal--14-130-75-75-c-70-iso8859-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4299 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4300 The font-name "NONE" can be used to revert to the default font.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4301 When setting the font for the "Normal" group, this becomes the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4302 font (until the 'guifont' option is changed; the last one set is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4303 used).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4304 The following only works with Motif and Athena, not with other GUIs:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4305 When setting the font for the "Menu" group, the menus will be changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4306 When setting the font for the "Tooltip" group, the tooltips will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4307 changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4308 All fonts used, except for Menu and Tooltip, should be of the same
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4309 character size as the default font! Otherwise redrawing problems will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4310 occur.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4311
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4312 guifg={color-name} *highlight-guifg*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4313 guibg={color-name} *highlight-guibg*
217
89114a6baf3c updated for version 7.0061
vimboss
parents: 169
diff changeset
4314 guisp={color-name} *highlight-guisp*
89114a6baf3c updated for version 7.0061
vimboss
parents: 169
diff changeset
4315 These give the foreground (guifg), background (guibg) and special
642
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4316 (guisp) color to use in the GUI. "guisp" is used for undercurl.
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4317 There are a few special names:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4318 NONE no color (transparent)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4319 bg use normal background color
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4320 background use normal background color
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4321 fg use normal foreground color
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4322 foreground use normal foreground color
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4323 To use a color name with an embedded space or other special character,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4324 put it in single quotes. The single quote cannot be used then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4325 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4326 :hi comment guifg='salmon pink'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4327 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4328 *gui-colors*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4329 Suggested color names (these are available on most systems):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4330 Red LightRed DarkRed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4331 Green LightGreen DarkGreen SeaGreen
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4332 Blue LightBlue DarkBlue SlateBlue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4333 Cyan LightCyan DarkCyan
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4334 Magenta LightMagenta DarkMagenta
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4335 Yellow LightYellow Brown DarkYellow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4336 Gray LightGray DarkGray
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4337 Black White
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4338 Orange Purple Violet
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4339
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4340 In the Win32 GUI version, additional system colors are available. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4341 |win32-colors|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4342
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4343 You can also specify a color by its Red, Green and Blue values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4344 The format is "#rrggbb", where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4345 "rr" is the Red value
217
89114a6baf3c updated for version 7.0061
vimboss
parents: 169
diff changeset
4346 "gg" is the Green value
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4347 "bb" is the Blue value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4348 All values are hexadecimal, range from "00" to "ff". Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4349 :highlight Comment guifg=#11f0c3 guibg=#ff00ff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4350 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4351 *highlight-groups* *highlight-default*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4352 These are the default highlighting groups. These groups are used by the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4353 'highlight' option default. Note that the highlighting depends on the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4354 of 'background'. You can see the current settings with the ":highlight"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4355 command.
2314
233eb4412f5d Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2304
diff changeset
4356 *hl-ColorColumn*
233eb4412f5d Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2304
diff changeset
4357 ColorColumn used for the columns set with 'colorcolumn'
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4358 *hl-Conceal*
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4359 Conceal placeholder characters substituted for concealed
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4360 text (see 'conceallevel')
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4361 *hl-Cursor*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4362 Cursor the character under the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4363 *hl-CursorIM*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4364 CursorIM like Cursor, but used when in IME mode |CursorIM|
746
0e81c2291705 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 720
diff changeset
4365 *hl-CursorColumn*
0e81c2291705 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 720
diff changeset
4366 CursorColumn the screen column that the cursor is in when 'cursorcolumn' is
0e81c2291705 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 720
diff changeset
4367 set
0e81c2291705 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 720
diff changeset
4368 *hl-CursorLine*
0e81c2291705 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 720
diff changeset
4369 CursorLine the screen line that the cursor is in when 'cursorline' is
0e81c2291705 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 720
diff changeset
4370 set
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4371 *hl-Directory*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4372 Directory directory names (and other special names in listings)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4373 *hl-DiffAdd*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4374 DiffAdd diff mode: Added line |diff.txt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4375 *hl-DiffChange*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4376 DiffChange diff mode: Changed line |diff.txt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4377 *hl-DiffDelete*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4378 DiffDelete diff mode: Deleted line |diff.txt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4379 *hl-DiffText*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4380 DiffText diff mode: Changed text within a changed line |diff.txt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4381 *hl-ErrorMsg*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4382 ErrorMsg error messages on the command line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4383 *hl-VertSplit*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4384 VertSplit the column separating vertically split windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4385 *hl-Folded*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4386 Folded line used for closed folds
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4387 *hl-FoldColumn*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4388 FoldColumn 'foldcolumn'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4389 *hl-SignColumn*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4390 SignColumn column where |signs| are displayed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4391 *hl-IncSearch*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4392 IncSearch 'incsearch' highlighting; also used for the text replaced with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4393 ":s///c"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4394 *hl-LineNr*
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
4395 LineNr Line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and when 'number'
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
4396 or 'relativenumber' option is set.
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
4397 *hl-MatchParen*
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
4398 MatchParen The character under the cursor or just before it, if it
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
4399 is a paired bracket, and its match. |pi_paren.txt|
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
4400
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4401 *hl-ModeMsg*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4402 ModeMsg 'showmode' message (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4403 *hl-MoreMsg*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4404 MoreMsg |more-prompt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4405 *hl-NonText*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4406 NonText '~' and '@' at the end of the window, characters from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4407 'showbreak' and other characters that do not really exist in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4408 the text (e.g., ">" displayed when a double-wide character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4409 doesn't fit at the end of the line).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4410 *hl-Normal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4411 Normal normal text
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4412 *hl-Pmenu*
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4413 Pmenu Popup menu: normal item.
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4414 *hl-PmenuSel*
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4415 PmenuSel Popup menu: selected item.
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4416 *hl-PmenuSbar*
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4417 PmenuSbar Popup menu: scrollbar.
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4418 *hl-PmenuThumb*
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4419 PmenuThumb Popup menu: Thumb of the scrollbar.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4420 *hl-Question*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4421 Question |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4422 *hl-Search*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4423 Search Last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch').
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4424 Also used for highlighting the current line in the quickfix
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4425 window and similar items that need to stand out.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4426 *hl-SpecialKey*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4427 SpecialKey Meta and special keys listed with ":map", also for text used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4428 to show unprintable characters in the text, 'listchars'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4429 Generally: text that is displayed differently from what it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4430 really is.
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4431 *hl-SpellBad*
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4432 SpellBad Word that is not recognized by the spellchecker. |spell|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4433 This will be combined with the highlighting used otherwise.
391
289b19a6f2ed updated for version 7.0103
vimboss
parents: 301
diff changeset
4434 *hl-SpellCap*
289b19a6f2ed updated for version 7.0103
vimboss
parents: 301
diff changeset
4435 SpellCap Word that should start with a capital. |spell|
289b19a6f2ed updated for version 7.0103
vimboss
parents: 301
diff changeset
4436 This will be combined with the highlighting used otherwise.
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4437 *hl-SpellLocal*
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4438 SpellLocal Word that is recognized by the spellchecker as one that is
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4439 used in another region. |spell|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4440 This will be combined with the highlighting used otherwise.
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4441 *hl-SpellRare*
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4442 SpellRare Word that is recognized by the spellchecker as one that is
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4443 hardly ever used. |spell|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4444 This will be combined with the highlighting used otherwise.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4445 *hl-StatusLine*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4446 StatusLine status line of current window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4447 *hl-StatusLineNC*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4448 StatusLineNC status lines of not-current windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4449 Note: if this is equal to "StatusLine" Vim will use "^^^" in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4450 the status line of the current window.
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 671
diff changeset
4451 *hl-TabLine*
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 671
diff changeset
4452 TabLine tab pages line, not active tab page label
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 671
diff changeset
4453 *hl-TabLineFill*
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 671
diff changeset
4454 TabLineFill tab pages line, where there are no labels
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 671
diff changeset
4455 *hl-TabLineSel*
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 671
diff changeset
4456 TabLineSel tab pages line, active tab page label
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4457 *hl-Title*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4458 Title titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4459 *hl-Visual*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4460 Visual Visual mode selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4461 *hl-VisualNOS*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4462 VisualNOS Visual mode selection when vim is "Not Owning the Selection".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4463 Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and |xterm-clipboard| supports this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4464 *hl-WarningMsg*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4465 WarningMsg warning messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4466 *hl-WildMenu*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4467 WildMenu current match in 'wildmenu' completion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4468
523
a7ae7e043e43 updated for version 7.0146
vimboss
parents: 501
diff changeset
4469 *hl-User1* *hl-User1..9* *hl-User9*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4470 The 'statusline' syntax allows the use of 9 different highlights in the
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
4471 statusline and ruler (via 'rulerformat'). The names are User1 to User9.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4472
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
4473 For the GUI you can use the following groups to set the colors for the menu,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4474 scrollbars and tooltips. They don't have defaults. This doesn't work for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4475 Win32 GUI. Only three highlight arguments have any effect here: font, guibg,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4476 and guifg.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4477
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4478 *hl-Menu*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4479 Menu Current font, background and foreground colors of the menus.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4480 Also used for the toolbar.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4481 Applicable highlight arguments: font, guibg, guifg.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4482
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4483 NOTE: For Motif and Athena the font argument actually
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4484 specifies a fontset at all times, no matter if 'guifontset' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4485 empty, and as such it is tied to the current |:language| when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4486 set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4487
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4488 *hl-Scrollbar*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4489 Scrollbar Current background and foreground of the main window's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4490 scrollbars.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4491 Applicable highlight arguments: guibg, guifg.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4492
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4493 *hl-Tooltip*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4494 Tooltip Current font, background and foreground of the tooltips.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4495 Applicable highlight arguments: font, guibg, guifg.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4496
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4497 NOTE: For Motif and Athena the font argument actually
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4498 specifies a fontset at all times, no matter if 'guifontset' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4499 empty, and as such it is tied to the current |:language| when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4500 set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4501
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4502 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4503 13. Linking groups *:hi-link* *:highlight-link* *E412* *E413*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4504
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4505 When you want to use the same highlighting for several syntax groups, you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4506 can do this more easily by linking the groups into one common highlight
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4507 group, and give the color attributes only for that group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4508
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4509 To set a link:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4510
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4511 :hi[ghlight][!] [default] link {from-group} {to-group}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4512
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4513 To remove a link:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4514
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4515 :hi[ghlight][!] [default] link {from-group} NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4516
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4517 Notes: *E414*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4518 - If the {from-group} and/or {to-group} doesn't exist, it is created. You
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4519 don't get an error message for a non-existing group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4520 - As soon as you use a ":highlight" command for a linked group, the link is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4521 removed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4522 - If there are already highlight settings for the {from-group}, the link is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4523 not made, unless the '!' is given. For a ":highlight link" command in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4524 sourced file, you don't get an error message. This can be used to skip
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4525 links for groups that already have settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4526
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4527 *:hi-default* *:highlight-default*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4528 The [default] argument is used for setting the default highlighting for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4529 group. If highlighting has already been specified for the group the command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4530 will be ignored. Also when there is an existing link.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4531
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4532 Using [default] is especially useful to overrule the highlighting of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4533 specific syntax file. For example, the C syntax file contains: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4534 :highlight default link cComment Comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4535 If you like Question highlighting for C comments, put this in your vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4536 :highlight link cComment Question
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4537 Without the "default" in the C syntax file, the highlighting would be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4538 overruled when the syntax file is loaded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4539
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4540 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4541 14. Cleaning up *:syn-clear* *E391*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4542
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4543 If you want to clear the syntax stuff for the current buffer, you can use this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4544 command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4545 :syntax clear
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4546
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4547 This command should be used when you want to switch off syntax highlighting,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4548 or when you want to switch to using another syntax. It's normally not needed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4549 in a syntax file itself, because syntax is cleared by the autocommands that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4550 load the syntax file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4551 The command also deletes the "b:current_syntax" variable, since no syntax is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4552 loaded after this command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4553
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4554 If you want to disable syntax highlighting for all buffers, you need to remove
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4555 the autocommands that load the syntax files: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4556 :syntax off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4557
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4558 What this command actually does, is executing the command >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4559 :source $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/nosyntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4560 See the "nosyntax.vim" file for details. Note that for this to work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4561 $VIMRUNTIME must be valid. See |$VIMRUNTIME|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4562
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4563 To clean up specific syntax groups for the current buffer: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4564 :syntax clear {group-name} ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4565 This removes all patterns and keywords for {group-name}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4566
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4567 To clean up specific syntax group lists for the current buffer: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4568 :syntax clear @{grouplist-name} ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4569 This sets {grouplist-name}'s contents to an empty list.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4570
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4571 *:syntax-reset* *:syn-reset*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4572 If you have changed the colors and messed them up, use this command to get the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4573 defaults back: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4574
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4575 :syntax reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4576
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4577 This doesn't change the colors for the 'highlight' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4578
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4579 Note that the syntax colors that you set in your vimrc file will also be reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4580 back to their Vim default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4581 Note that if you are using a color scheme, the colors defined by the color
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4582 scheme for syntax highlighting will be lost.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4583
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4584 What this actually does is: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4585
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4586 let g:syntax_cmd = "reset"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4587 runtime! syntax/syncolor.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4588
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4589 Note that this uses the 'runtimepath' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4590
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4591 *syncolor*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4592 If you want to use different colors for syntax highlighting, you can add a Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4593 script file to set these colors. Put this file in a directory in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4594 'runtimepath' which comes after $VIMRUNTIME, so that your settings overrule
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4595 the default colors. This way these colors will be used after the ":syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4596 reset" command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4597
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4598 For Unix you can use the file ~/.vim/after/syntax/syncolor.vim. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4599
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4600 if &background == "light"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4601 highlight comment ctermfg=darkgreen guifg=darkgreen
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4602 else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4603 highlight comment ctermfg=green guifg=green
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4604 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4605
24
8ff7fd162d3c updated for version 7.0016
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
4606 *E679*
8ff7fd162d3c updated for version 7.0016
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
4607 Do make sure this syncolor.vim script does not use a "syntax on", set the
8ff7fd162d3c updated for version 7.0016
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
4608 'background' option or uses a "colorscheme" command, because it results in an
8ff7fd162d3c updated for version 7.0016
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
4609 endless loop.
8ff7fd162d3c updated for version 7.0016
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
4610
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4611 Note that when a color scheme is used, there might be some confusion whether
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4612 your defined colors are to be used or the colors from the scheme. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4613 depends on the color scheme file. See |:colorscheme|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4614
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4615 *syntax_cmd*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4616 The "syntax_cmd" variable is set to one of these values when the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4617 syntax/syncolor.vim files are loaded:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4618 "on" ":syntax on" command. Highlight colors are overruled but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4619 links are kept
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4620 "enable" ":syntax enable" command. Only define colors for groups that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4621 don't have highlighting yet. Use ":syntax default".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4622 "reset" ":syntax reset" command or loading a color scheme. Define all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4623 the colors.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4624 "skip" Don't define colors. Used to skip the default settings when a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4625 syncolor.vim file earlier in 'runtimepath' has already set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4626 them.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4627
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4628 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4629 15. Highlighting tags *tag-highlight*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4630
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4631 If you want to highlight all the tags in your file, you can use the following
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4632 mappings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4633
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4634 <F11> -- Generate tags.vim file, and highlight tags.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4635 <F12> -- Just highlight tags based on existing tags.vim file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4636 >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4637 :map <F11> :sp tags<CR>:%s/^\([^ :]*:\)\=\([^ ]*\).*/syntax keyword Tag \2/<CR>:wq! tags.vim<CR>/^<CR><F12>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4638 :map <F12> :so tags.vim<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4639
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4640 WARNING: The longer the tags file, the slower this will be, and the more
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4641 memory Vim will consume.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4642
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4643 Only highlighting typedefs, unions and structs can be done too. For this you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4644 must use Exuberant ctags (found at http://ctags.sf.net).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4645
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4646 Put these lines in your Makefile:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4647
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4648 # Make a highlight file for types. Requires Exuberant ctags and awk
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4649 types: types.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4650 types.vim: *.[ch]
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
4651 ctags --c-kinds=gstu -o- *.[ch] |\
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4652 awk 'BEGIN{printf("syntax keyword Type\t")}\
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4653 {printf("%s ", $$1)}END{print ""}' > $@
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4654
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4655 And put these lines in your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4656
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4657 " load the types.vim highlighting file, if it exists
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4658 autocmd BufRead,BufNewFile *.[ch] let fname = expand('<afile>:p:h') . '/types.vim'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4659 autocmd BufRead,BufNewFile *.[ch] if filereadable(fname)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4660 autocmd BufRead,BufNewFile *.[ch] exe 'so ' . fname
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4661 autocmd BufRead,BufNewFile *.[ch] endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4662
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4663 ==============================================================================
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4664 16. Window-local syntax *:ownsyntax*
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4665
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4666 Normally all windows on a buffer share the same syntax settings. It is
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4667 possible, however, to set a particular window on a file to have its own
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4668 private syntax setting. A possible example would be to edit LaTeX source
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4669 with conventional highlighting in one window, while seeing the same source
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4670 highlighted differently (so as to hide control sequences and indicate bold,
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4671 italic etc regions) in another. The 'scrollbind' option is useful here.
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4672
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4673 To set the current window to have the syntax "foo", separately from all other
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4674 windows on the buffer: >
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4675 :ownsyntax foo
2254
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4676 < *w:current_syntax*
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4677 This will set the "w:current_syntax" variable to "foo". The value of
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4678 "b:current_syntax" does not change. This is implemented by saving and
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4679 restoring "b:current_syntax", since the syntax files do set
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4680 "b:current_syntax". The value set by the syntax file is assigned to
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4681 "w:current_syntax".
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4682
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4683 Once a window has its own syntax, syntax commands executed from other windows
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4684 on the same buffer (including :syntax clear) have no effect. Conversely,
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4685 syntax commands executed from that window do not effect other windows on the
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4686 same buffer.
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4687
2254
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4688 A window with its own syntax reverts to normal behavior when another buffer
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4689 is loaded into that window or the file is reloaded.
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4690 When splitting the window, the new window will use the original syntax.
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4691
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4692 ==============================================================================
2581
e8a482a7fa6c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
4693 17. Color xterms *xterm-color* *color-xterm*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4694
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4695 Most color xterms have only eight colors. If you don't get colors with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4696 default setup, it should work with these lines in your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4697 :if &term =~ "xterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4698 : if has("terminfo")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4699 : set t_Co=8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4700 : set t_Sf=<Esc>[3%p1%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4701 : set t_Sb=<Esc>[4%p1%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4702 : else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4703 : set t_Co=8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4704 : set t_Sf=<Esc>[3%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4705 : set t_Sb=<Esc>[4%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4706 : endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4707 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4708 < [<Esc> is a real escape, type CTRL-V <Esc>]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4709
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4710 You might want to change the first "if" to match the name of your terminal,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4711 e.g. "dtterm" instead of "xterm".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4712
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4713 Note: Do these settings BEFORE doing ":syntax on". Otherwise the colors may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4714 be wrong.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4715 *xiterm* *rxvt*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4716 The above settings have been mentioned to work for xiterm and rxvt too.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4717 But for using 16 colors in an rxvt these should work with terminfo: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4718 :set t_AB=<Esc>[%?%p1%{8}%<%t25;%p1%{40}%+%e5;%p1%{32}%+%;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4719 :set t_AF=<Esc>[%?%p1%{8}%<%t22;%p1%{30}%+%e1;%p1%{22}%+%;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4720 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4721 *colortest.vim*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4722 To test your color setup, a file has been included in the Vim distribution.
671
83a006f81bac updated for version 7.0199
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
4723 To use it, execute this command: >
83a006f81bac updated for version 7.0199
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
4724 :runtime syntax/colortest.vim
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4725
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
4726 Some versions of xterm (and other terminals, like the Linux console) can
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4727 output lighter foreground colors, even though the number of colors is defined
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4728 at 8. Therefore Vim sets the "cterm=bold" attribute for light foreground
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4729 colors, when 't_Co' is 8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4730
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4731 *xfree-xterm*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4732 To get 16 colors or more, get the newest xterm version (which should be
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
4733 included with XFree86 3.3 and later). You can also find the latest version
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4734 at: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4735 http://invisible-island.net/xterm/xterm.html
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4736 Here is a good way to configure it. This uses 88 colors and enables the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4737 termcap-query feature, which allows Vim to ask the xterm how many colors it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4738 supports. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4739 ./configure --disable-bold-color --enable-88-color --enable-tcap-query
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4740 If you only get 8 colors, check the xterm compilation settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4741 (Also see |UTF8-xterm| for using this xterm with UTF-8 character encoding).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4742
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4743 This xterm should work with these lines in your .vimrc (for 16 colors): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4744 :if has("terminfo")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4745 : set t_Co=16
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4746 : set t_AB=<Esc>[%?%p1%{8}%<%t%p1%{40}%+%e%p1%{92}%+%;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4747 : set t_AF=<Esc>[%?%p1%{8}%<%t%p1%{30}%+%e%p1%{82}%+%;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4748 :else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4749 : set t_Co=16
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4750 : set t_Sf=<Esc>[3%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4751 : set t_Sb=<Esc>[4%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4752 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4753 < [<Esc> is a real escape, type CTRL-V <Esc>]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4754
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4755 Without |+terminfo|, Vim will recognize these settings, and automatically
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4756 translate cterm colors of 8 and above to "<Esc>[9%dm" and "<Esc>[10%dm".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4757 Colors above 16 are also translated automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4758
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4759 For 256 colors this has been reported to work: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4760
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4761 :set t_AB=<Esc>[48;5;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4762 :set t_AF=<Esc>[38;5;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4763
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4764 Or just set the TERM environment variable to "xterm-color" or "xterm-16color"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4765 and try if that works.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4766
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4767 You probably want to use these X resources (in your ~/.Xdefaults file):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4768 XTerm*color0: #000000
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4769 XTerm*color1: #c00000
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4770 XTerm*color2: #008000
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4771 XTerm*color3: #808000
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4772 XTerm*color4: #0000c0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4773 XTerm*color5: #c000c0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4774 XTerm*color6: #008080
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4775 XTerm*color7: #c0c0c0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4776 XTerm*color8: #808080
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4777 XTerm*color9: #ff6060
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4778 XTerm*color10: #00ff00
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4779 XTerm*color11: #ffff00
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4780 XTerm*color12: #8080ff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4781 XTerm*color13: #ff40ff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4782 XTerm*color14: #00ffff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4783 XTerm*color15: #ffffff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4784 Xterm*cursorColor: Black
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4785
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4786 [Note: The cursorColor is required to work around a bug, which changes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4787 cursor color to the color of the last drawn text. This has been fixed by a
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
4788 newer version of xterm, but not everybody is using it yet.]
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4789
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4790 To get these right away, reload the .Xdefaults file to the X Option database
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4791 Manager (you only need to do this when you just changed the .Xdefaults file): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4792 xrdb -merge ~/.Xdefaults
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4793 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4794 *xterm-blink* *xterm-blinking-cursor*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4795 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see tools/blink.c. Or use Thomas
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4796 Dickey's xterm above patchlevel 107 (see above for where to get it), with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4797 these resources:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4798 XTerm*cursorBlink: on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4799 XTerm*cursorOnTime: 400
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4800 XTerm*cursorOffTime: 250
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4801 XTerm*cursorColor: White
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4802
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4803 *hpterm-color*
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
4804 These settings work (more or less) for an hpterm, which only supports 8
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4805 foreground colors: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4806 :if has("terminfo")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4807 : set t_Co=8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4808 : set t_Sf=<Esc>[&v%p1%dS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4809 : set t_Sb=<Esc>[&v7S
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4810 :else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4811 : set t_Co=8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4812 : set t_Sf=<Esc>[&v%dS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4813 : set t_Sb=<Esc>[&v7S
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4814 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4815 < [<Esc> is a real escape, type CTRL-V <Esc>]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4816
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4817 *Eterm* *enlightened-terminal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4818 These settings have been reported to work for the Enlightened terminal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4819 emulator, or Eterm. They might work for all xterm-like terminals that use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4820 bold attribute to get bright colors. Add an ":if" like above when needed. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4821 :set t_Co=16
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4822 :set t_AF=^[[%?%p1%{8}%<%t3%p1%d%e%p1%{22}%+%d;1%;m
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4823 :set t_AB=^[[%?%p1%{8}%<%t4%p1%d%e%p1%{32}%+%d;1%;m
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4824 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4825 *TTpro-telnet*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4826 These settings should work for TTpro telnet. Tera Term Pro is a freeware /
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4827 open-source program for MS-Windows. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4828 set t_Co=16
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4829 set t_AB=^[[%?%p1%{8}%<%t%p1%{40}%+%e%p1%{32}%+5;%;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4830 set t_AF=^[[%?%p1%{8}%<%t%p1%{30}%+%e%p1%{22}%+1;%;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4831 Also make sure TTpro's Setup / Window / Full Color is enabled, and make sure
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4832 that Setup / Font / Enable Bold is NOT enabled.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4833 (info provided by John Love-Jensen <eljay@Adobe.COM>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4834
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4835 vim:tw=78:sw=4:ts=8:ft=help:norl: